blob: ddde907522b92bd264181af8332e1d3b2ccc821e [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00001//===--- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes ------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements the ASTContext interface.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000015#include "CXXABI.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000016#include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
17#include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +000018#include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000019#include "clang/AST/Comment.h"
Dmitri Gribenkoca7f80a2012-08-09 00:03:17 +000020#include "clang/AST/CommentCommandTraits.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
Steve Naroff67391b82007-10-01 19:00:59 +000022#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorded2d7b2009-02-04 19:02:06 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +000024#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h"
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +000027#include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +000028#include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000029#include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +000030#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000031#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +000032#include "clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h"
Chris Lattner15ba9492009-06-14 01:54:56 +000033#include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
Chris Lattnerd2868512009-03-28 03:45:20 +000034#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner4dc8a6f2007-05-20 23:50:58 +000035#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000036#include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +000037#include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +000038#include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000039#include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h"
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +000040#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000041#include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +000042#include <map>
Anders Carlssona4267a62009-07-18 21:19:52 +000043
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +000044using namespace clang;
45
Douglas Gregor9672f922010-07-03 00:47:00 +000046unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructors;
47unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregora6d69502010-07-02 23:41:54 +000048unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructors;
49unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000050unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructors;
51unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor330b9cf2010-07-02 21:50:04 +000052unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators;
53unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000054unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators;
55unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +000056unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructors;
57unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared;
58
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000059enum FloatingRank {
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +000060 HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000061};
62
Dmitri Gribenkof26054f2012-07-11 21:38:39 +000063RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000064 if (!CommentsLoaded && ExternalSource) {
65 ExternalSource->ReadComments();
Dmitri Gribenko9ee0e302014-03-27 15:40:39 +000066
67#ifndef NDEBUG
68 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
69 assert(std::is_sorted(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
70 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment>(SourceMgr)));
71#endif
72
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000073 CommentsLoaded = true;
74 }
75
76 assert(D);
77
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000078 // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations.
79 if (D->isImplicit())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000080 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000081
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000082 // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations.
83 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
84 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000085 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000086 }
87
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000088 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
89 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
90 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000091 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000092 }
93
94 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
95 if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000096 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000097 }
98
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +000099 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
100 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
101 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind();
102 if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
103 TSK == TSK_Undeclared)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000104 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000105 }
106
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000107 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
108 if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000109 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000110 }
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000111 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
112 // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the
113 // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment
114 if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000115 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000116 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000117 // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly.
118 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000119 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000120
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000121 // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template
122 // documentation.
123 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) ||
124 isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) ||
125 isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000126 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000127
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000128 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000129
130 // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything.
131 if (RawComments.empty())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000132 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000133
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000134 // Find declaration location.
135 // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple
136 // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration
137 // location".
138 // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently,
139 // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location".
140 SourceLocation DeclLoc;
141 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000142 isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko7f4b3772012-08-02 20:49:51 +0000143 isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) ||
144 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D))
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000145 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000146 else {
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000147 DeclLoc = D->getLocation();
Dmitri Gribenkoef099dc2014-03-27 16:40:51 +0000148 if (DeclLoc.isMacroID()) {
149 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
150 // If location of the typedef name is in a macro, it is because being
151 // declared via a macro. Try using declaration's starting location as
152 // the "declaration location".
153 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
154 } else if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
155 // If location of the tag decl is inside a macro, but the spelling of
156 // the tag name comes from a macro argument, it looks like a special
157 // macro like NS_ENUM is being used to define the tag decl. In that
158 // case, adjust the source location to the expansion loc so that we can
159 // attach the comment to the tag decl.
160 if (SourceMgr.isMacroArgExpansion(DeclLoc) &&
161 TD->isCompleteDefinition())
162 DeclLoc = SourceMgr.getExpansionLoc(DeclLoc);
163 }
164 }
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000165 }
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000166
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000167 // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
168 // can't find the comment.
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000169 if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000170 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000171
172 // Find the comment that occurs just after this declaration.
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000173 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator Comment;
174 {
175 // When searching for comments during parsing, the comment we are looking
176 // for is usually among the last two comments we parsed -- check them
177 // first.
Dmitri Gribenkoa7d16ce2013-04-10 15:35:17 +0000178 RawComment CommentAtDeclLoc(
179 SourceMgr, SourceRange(DeclLoc), false,
180 LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments);
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000181 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment> Compare(SourceMgr);
182 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator MaybeBeforeDecl = RawComments.end() - 1;
183 bool Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
184 if (!Found && RawComments.size() >= 2) {
185 MaybeBeforeDecl--;
186 Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
187 }
188
189 if (Found) {
190 Comment = MaybeBeforeDecl + 1;
191 assert(Comment == std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
192 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare));
193 } else {
194 // Slow path.
195 Comment = std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
196 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare);
197 }
198 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000199
200 // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the
201 // file buffer.
202 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc);
203
204 // First check whether we have a trailing comment.
205 if (Comment != RawComments.end() &&
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000206 (*Comment)->isDocumentation() && (*Comment)->isTrailingComment() &&
Fariborz Jahanianfad28542013-08-06 23:29:00 +0000207 (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) ||
Fariborz Jahanian3ab62222013-08-07 16:40:29 +0000208 isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000209 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentBeginDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000210 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getBegin());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000211 // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts
212 // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration.
213 if (DeclLocDecomp.first == CommentBeginDecomp.first &&
214 SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second)
215 == SourceMgr.getLineNumber(CommentBeginDecomp.first,
216 CommentBeginDecomp.second)) {
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000217 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000218 }
219 }
220
221 // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment.
222 // Let's look at the previous comment.
223 if (Comment == RawComments.begin())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000224 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000225 --Comment;
226
227 // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment.
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000228 if (!(*Comment)->isDocumentation() || (*Comment)->isTrailingComment())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000229 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000230
231 // Decompose the end of the comment.
232 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentEndDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000233 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000234
235 // If the comment and the declaration aren't in the same file, then they
236 // aren't related.
237 if (DeclLocDecomp.first != CommentEndDecomp.first)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000238 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000239
240 // Get the corresponding buffer.
241 bool Invalid = false;
242 const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first,
243 &Invalid).data();
244 if (Invalid)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000245 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000246
247 // Extract text between the comment and declaration.
248 StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndDecomp.second,
249 DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndDecomp.second);
250
Dmitri Gribenko7e8729b2012-06-27 23:43:37 +0000251 // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between
252 // comment and declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb534d3a2013-07-26 18:38:12 +0000253 if (Text.find_first_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000254 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000255
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000256 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000257}
258
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000259namespace {
260/// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to
261/// refer to the actual template.
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000262/// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template.
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000263const Decl *adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl *D) {
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000264 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000265 // Is this function declaration part of a function template?
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000266 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000267 return FTD;
268
269 // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation.
270 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
271 return D;
272
273 // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template?
274 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate())
275 return FTD;
276
277 // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
278 if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl =
279 FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction())
280 return MemberDecl;
281
282 return D;
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000283 }
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000284 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
285 // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class
286 // template?
287 if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
288 if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember())
289 return MemberDecl;
290
291 return D;
292 }
293 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
294 // Is this class declaration part of a class template?
295 if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
296 return CTD;
297
298 // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial
299 // specialization?
300 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
301 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) {
302 if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
303 return D;
304 llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *,
305 ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>
306 PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial();
307 return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl*>() ?
308 static_cast<const Decl*>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>()) :
309 static_cast<const Decl*>(
310 PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>());
311 }
312
313 // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
314 if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info =
315 CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
316 return Info->getInstantiatedFrom();
317
318 return D;
319 }
320 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
321 // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
322 if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum())
323 return MemberDecl;
324
325 return D;
326 }
327 // FIXME: Adjust alias templates?
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000328 return D;
329}
330} // unnamed namespace
331
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000332const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(
333 const Decl *D,
334 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const {
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000335 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000336
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000337 // Check whether we have cached a comment for this declaration already.
338 {
339 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
340 RedeclComments.find(D);
341 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
342 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000343 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
344 if (OriginalDecl)
345 *OriginalDecl = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000346 return Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000347 }
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000348 }
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000349 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000350
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000351 // Search for comments attached to declarations in the redeclaration chain.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000352 const RawComment *RC = nullptr;
353 const Decl *OriginalDeclForRC = nullptr;
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000354 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000355 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000356 RedeclComments.find(I);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000357 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
358 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
359 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
360 RC = Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000361 OriginalDeclForRC = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000362 break;
363 }
364 } else {
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000365 RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(I);
366 OriginalDeclForRC = I;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000367 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
368 if (RC) {
369 Raw.setRaw(RC);
370 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromDecl);
371 } else
372 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl);
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000373 Raw.setOriginalDecl(I);
374 RedeclComments[I] = Raw;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000375 if (RC)
376 break;
377 }
378 }
379
Dmitri Gribenko5c8897d2012-06-28 16:25:36 +0000380 // If we found a comment, it should be a documentation comment.
381 assert(!RC || RC->isDocumentation());
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000382
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000383 if (OriginalDecl)
384 *OriginalDecl = OriginalDeclForRC;
385
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000386 // Update cache for every declaration in the redeclaration chain.
387 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
388 Raw.setRaw(RC);
389 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromRedecl);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000390 Raw.setOriginalDecl(OriginalDeclForRC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000391
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000392 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
393 RawCommentAndCacheFlags &R = RedeclComments[I];
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000394 if (R.getKind() == RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl)
395 R = Raw;
396 }
397
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000398 return RC;
399}
400
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000401static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod,
402 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) {
403 const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext();
404 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) {
405 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface();
406 if (!ID)
407 return;
408 // Add redeclared method here.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +0000409 for (const auto *Ext : ID->known_extensions()) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000410 if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod =
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +0000411 Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(),
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000412 ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod()))
413 Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod);
414 }
415 }
416}
417
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000418comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC,
419 const Decl *D) const {
420 comments::DeclInfo *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo;
421 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D;
422 ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false;
423 ThisDeclInfo->fill();
424 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7daabbd2014-04-27 22:53:03 +0000425 if (!ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters)
426 ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters = FC->getDeclInfo()->TemplateParameters;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000427 comments::FullComment *CFC =
428 new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(),
429 ThisDeclInfo);
430 return CFC;
431
432}
433
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000434comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const {
435 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000436 return RC ? RC->parse(*this, nullptr, D) : nullptr;
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000437}
438
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000439comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl(
440 const Decl *D,
441 const Preprocessor *PP) const {
Fariborz Jahanian096f7c12013-05-13 17:27:00 +0000442 if (D->isInvalidDecl())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000443 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000444 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000445
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000446 const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl();
447 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos =
448 ParsedComments.find(Canonical);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000449
450 if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000451 if (Canonical != D) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000452 comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000453 comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000454 return CFC;
455 }
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000456 return Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000457 }
458
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000459 const Decl *OriginalDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000460
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000461 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000462 if (!RC) {
463 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000464 SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden;
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000465 const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000466 if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor())
467 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl())
468 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP))
469 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000470 if (OMD)
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000471 addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden);
472 getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000473 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++)
474 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP))
475 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000476 }
Fariborz Jahanian6384fbb2013-05-02 15:44:16 +0000477 else if (const TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000478 // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000479 // does not have one of its own.
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000480 QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType();
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000481 if (const TagType *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>())
482 if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl())
483 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP))
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000484 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000485 }
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000486 else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
487 while (IC->getSuperClass()) {
488 IC = IC->getSuperClass();
489 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
490 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
491 }
492 }
493 else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) {
494 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface())
495 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
496 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
497 }
498 else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
499 if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000500 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000501 // Check non-virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000502 for (const auto &I : RD->bases()) {
503 if (I.isVirtual() || (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public))
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000504 continue;
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000505 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000506 if (Ty.isNull())
507 continue;
508 if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
509 if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition()))
510 continue;
511
512 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP))
513 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
514 }
515 }
516 // Check virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000517 for (const auto &I : RD->vbases()) {
518 if (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)
Fariborz Jahanian5a2e4a22013-04-26 23:34:36 +0000519 continue;
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000520 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000521 if (Ty.isNull())
522 continue;
523 if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
524 if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition()))
525 continue;
526 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP))
527 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
528 }
529 }
530 }
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000531 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000532 }
533
Dmitri Gribenkobfda9f72012-08-22 18:12:19 +0000534 // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we
535 // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl. This is important
536 // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be
537 // different across redeclarations.
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000538 if (D != OriginalDecl)
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000539 return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000540
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000541 comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D);
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000542 ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC;
543 return FC;
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000544}
545
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000546void
547ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
548 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) {
549 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth());
550 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition());
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000551 ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack());
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000552
553 TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters();
554 ID.AddInteger(Params->size());
555 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
556 PEnd = Params->end();
557 P != PEnd; ++P) {
558 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
559 ID.AddInteger(0);
560 ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack());
561 continue;
562 }
563
564 if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
565 ID.AddInteger(1);
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000566 ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000567 ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000568 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
569 ID.AddBoolean(true);
570 ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000571 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
572 QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I);
573 ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
574 }
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000575 } else
576 ID.AddBoolean(false);
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000577 continue;
578 }
579
580 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P);
581 ID.AddInteger(2);
582 Profile(ID, TTP);
583 }
584}
585
586TemplateTemplateParmDecl *
587ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +0000588 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const {
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000589 // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter.
590 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
591 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, TTP);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000592 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000593 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical
594 = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
595 if (Canonical)
596 return Canonical->getParam();
597
598 // Build a canonical template parameter list.
599 TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters();
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000600 SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000601 CanonParams.reserve(Params->size());
602 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
603 PEnd = Params->end();
604 P != PEnd; ++P) {
605 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P))
606 CanonParams.push_back(
607 TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnarab3185b02011-03-06 15:48:19 +0000608 SourceLocation(),
609 SourceLocation(),
610 TTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000611 TTP->getIndex(), nullptr, false,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000612 TTP->isParameterPack()));
613 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000614 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
615 QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType());
616 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
617 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
618 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000619 SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes;
620 SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos;
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000621 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
622 ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I)));
623 ExpandedTInfos.push_back(
624 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back()));
625 }
626
627 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000628 SourceLocation(),
629 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000630 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000631 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000632 T,
633 TInfo,
634 ExpandedTypes.data(),
635 ExpandedTypes.size(),
636 ExpandedTInfos.data());
637 } else {
638 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000639 SourceLocation(),
640 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000641 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000642 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000643 T,
644 NTTP->isParameterPack(),
645 TInfo);
646 }
647 CanonParams.push_back(Param);
648
649 } else
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000650 CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
651 cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P)));
652 }
653
654 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP
655 = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
656 SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(),
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000657 TTP->getPosition(),
658 TTP->isParameterPack(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000659 nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000660 TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(),
661 SourceLocation(),
662 CanonParams.data(),
663 CanonParams.size(),
664 SourceLocation()));
665
666 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
667 Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000668 assert(!Canonical && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000669 (void)Canonical;
670
671 // Create the canonical template template parameter entry.
672 Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP);
673 CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos);
674 return CanonTTP;
675}
676
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000677CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000678 if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return nullptr;
John McCall86353412010-08-21 22:46:04 +0000679
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000680 switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000681 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM: // Same as Itanium at this level
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000682 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +0000683 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000684 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000685 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000686 return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this);
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000687 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Charles Davis6bcb07a2010-08-19 02:18:14 +0000688 return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this);
689 }
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +0000690 llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!");
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000691}
692
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000693static const LangAS::Map *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T,
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000694 const LangOptions &LOpts) {
695 if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) {
696 // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each
697 // language-specific address space.
698 static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = {
699 1, // opencl_global
700 2, // opencl_local
Peter Collingbournef44bdf92012-05-20 21:08:35 +0000701 3, // opencl_constant
702 4, // cuda_device
703 5, // cuda_constant
704 6 // cuda_shared
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000705 };
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000706 return &FakeAddrSpaceMap;
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000707 } else {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000708 return &T.getAddressSpaceMap();
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000709 }
710}
711
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000712static bool isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo &TI,
713 const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
714 switch (LangOpts.getAddressSpaceMapMangling()) {
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000715 case LangOptions::ASMM_Target:
716 return TI.useAddressSpaceMapMangling();
717 case LangOptions::ASMM_On:
718 return true;
719 case LangOptions::ASMM_Off:
720 return false;
721 }
NAKAMURA Takumi5c81ca42013-09-13 17:12:09 +0000722 llvm_unreachable("getAddressSpaceMapMangling() doesn't cover anything.");
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000723}
724
Douglas Gregor7018d5b2011-09-01 20:23:19 +0000725ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions& LOpts, SourceManager &SM,
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000726 IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels,
Alp Toker08043432014-05-03 03:46:04 +0000727 Builtin::Context &builtins)
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000728 : FunctionProtoTypes(this_()),
729 TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
730 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
731 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000732 GlobalNestedNameSpecifier(nullptr),
733 Int128Decl(nullptr), UInt128Decl(nullptr), Float128StubDecl(nullptr),
734 BuiltinVaListDecl(nullptr),
735 ObjCIdDecl(nullptr), ObjCSelDecl(nullptr), ObjCClassDecl(nullptr),
736 ObjCProtocolClassDecl(nullptr), BOOLDecl(nullptr),
737 CFConstantStringTypeDecl(nullptr), ObjCInstanceTypeDecl(nullptr),
738 FILEDecl(nullptr),
739 jmp_bufDecl(nullptr), sigjmp_bufDecl(nullptr), ucontext_tDecl(nullptr),
740 BlockDescriptorType(nullptr), BlockDescriptorExtendedType(nullptr),
741 cudaConfigureCallDecl(nullptr),
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +0000742 NullTypeSourceInfo(QualType()),
743 FirstLocalImport(), LastLocalImport(),
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000744 SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000745 AddrSpaceMap(nullptr), Target(nullptr), PrintingPolicy(LOpts),
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000746 Idents(idents), Selectors(sels),
747 BuiltinInfo(builtins),
748 DeclarationNames(*this),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000749 ExternalSource(nullptr), Listener(nullptr),
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000750 Comments(SM), CommentsLoaded(false),
Dmitri Gribenkoacf2e782013-02-22 14:21:27 +0000751 CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000752 LastSDM(nullptr, 0)
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000753{
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000754 TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this);
755}
756
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000757ASTContext::~ASTContext() {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000758 ReleaseParentMapEntries();
759
Ted Kremenekda4e0d32010-02-11 07:12:28 +0000760 // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects.
761 // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution?
762 ReleaseDeclContextMaps();
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +0000763
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000764 // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets.
765 for (DeallocationMap::const_iterator I = Deallocations.begin(),
766 E = Deallocations.end(); I != E; ++I)
767 for (unsigned J = 0, N = I->second.size(); J != N; ++J)
768 (I->first)((I->second)[J]);
769
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000770 // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000771 // because they can contain DenseMaps.
772 for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*,
773 const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
774 I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; )
775 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
776 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
777 R->Destroy(*this);
778
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000779 for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
780 I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) {
781 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
782 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
783 R->Destroy(*this);
784 }
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000785
786 for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(),
787 AEnd = DeclAttrs.end();
788 A != AEnd; ++A)
789 A->second->~AttrVec();
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +0000790
Reid Kleckner588c9372014-02-19 23:44:52 +0000791 llvm::DeleteContainerSeconds(MangleNumberingContexts);
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000792}
Douglas Gregorf21eb492009-03-26 23:50:42 +0000793
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000794void ASTContext::ReleaseParentMapEntries() {
795 if (!AllParents) return;
796 for (const auto &Entry : *AllParents) {
797 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
798 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
799 } else {
800 assert(Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>());
801 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
802 }
803 }
804}
805
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000806void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void*), void *Data) {
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000807 Deallocations[Callback].push_back(Data);
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000808}
809
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000810void
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000811ASTContext::setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source) {
812 ExternalSource = Source;
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000813}
814
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000815void ASTContext::PrintStats() const {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000816 llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n";
817 llvm::errs() << " " << Types.size() << " types total.\n";
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +0000818
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000819 unsigned counts[] = {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000820#define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0,
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000821#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
822#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
823 0 // Extra
824 };
Douglas Gregorb1fe2c92009-04-07 17:20:56 +0000825
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000826 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) {
827 Type *T = Types[i];
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000828 counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++;
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000829 }
830
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000831 unsigned Idx = 0;
832 unsigned TotalBytes = 0;
833#define TYPE(Name, Parent) \
834 if (counts[Idx]) \
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000835 llvm::errs() << " " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name \
836 << " types\n"; \
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000837 TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type); \
838 ++Idx;
839#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
840#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000841
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000842 llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n";
843
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +0000844 // Implicit special member functions.
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000845 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/"
846 << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors
847 << " implicit default constructors created\n";
848 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/"
849 << NumImplicitCopyConstructors
850 << " implicit copy constructors created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000851 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000852 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/"
853 << NumImplicitMoveConstructors
854 << " implicit move constructors created\n";
855 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
856 << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators
857 << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000858 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000859 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
860 << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators
861 << " implicit move assignment operators created\n";
862 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/"
863 << NumImplicitDestructors
864 << " implicit destructors created\n";
865
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000866 if (ExternalSource) {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000867 llvm::errs() << "\n";
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000868 ExternalSource->PrintStats();
869 }
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000870
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000871 BumpAlloc.PrintStats();
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000872}
873
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000874RecordDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name,
875 RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000876 SourceLocation Loc;
877 RecordDecl *NewDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000878 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
879 NewDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc,
880 Loc, &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000881 else
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000882 NewDecl = RecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, Loc,
883 &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000884 NewDecl->setImplicit();
885 return NewDecl;
886}
887
888TypedefDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T,
889 StringRef Name) const {
890 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
891 TypedefDecl *NewDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(
892 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), getTranslationUnitDecl(),
893 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Name), TInfo);
894 NewDecl->setImplicit();
895 return NewDecl;
896}
897
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000898TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000899 if (!Int128Decl)
900 Int128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(Int128Ty, "__int128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000901 return Int128Decl;
902}
903
904TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000905 if (!UInt128Decl)
906 UInt128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(UnsignedInt128Ty, "__uint128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000907 return UInt128Decl;
908}
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000909
Nico Webere1687c52013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000910TypeDecl *ASTContext::getFloat128StubType() const {
Nico Weber5b0b46f2013-06-21 01:29:36 +0000911 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus && "should only be called for c++");
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000912 if (!Float128StubDecl)
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000913 Float128StubDecl = buildImplicitRecord("__float128");
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000914
Nico Webere1687c52013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000915 return Float128StubDecl;
916}
917
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000918void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000919 BuiltinType *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K);
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000920 R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0));
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000921 Types.push_back(Ty);
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000922}
923
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000924void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target) {
925 assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) &&
926 "Incorrect target reinitialization");
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000927 assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000928
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000929 this->Target = &Target;
930
931 ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target));
932 AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts);
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000933 AddrSpaceMapMangling = isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(Target, LangOpts);
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000934
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000935 // C99 6.2.5p19.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000936 InitBuiltinType(VoidTy, BuiltinType::Void);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000937
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000938 // C99 6.2.5p2.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000939 InitBuiltinType(BoolTy, BuiltinType::Bool);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000940 // C99 6.2.5p3.
Eli Friedman9ffd4a92009-06-05 07:05:05 +0000941 if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned)
Chris Lattnerb16f4552007-06-03 07:25:34 +0000942 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_S);
943 else
944 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_U);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000945 // C99 6.2.5p4.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000946 InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy, BuiltinType::SChar);
947 InitBuiltinType(ShortTy, BuiltinType::Short);
948 InitBuiltinType(IntTy, BuiltinType::Int);
949 InitBuiltinType(LongTy, BuiltinType::Long);
950 InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy, BuiltinType::LongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000951
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000952 // C99 6.2.5p6.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000953 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy, BuiltinType::UChar);
954 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy, BuiltinType::UShort);
955 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy, BuiltinType::UInt);
956 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy, BuiltinType::ULong);
957 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy, BuiltinType::ULongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000958
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000959 // C99 6.2.5p10.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000960 InitBuiltinType(FloatTy, BuiltinType::Float);
961 InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy, BuiltinType::Double);
962 InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy, BuiltinType::LongDouble);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +0000963
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +0000964 // GNU extension, 128-bit integers.
965 InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty, BuiltinType::Int128);
966 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty, BuiltinType::UInt128);
967
Hans Wennborg0d81e012013-05-10 10:08:40 +0000968 // C++ 3.9.1p5
969 if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType()))
970 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_S);
971 else // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned.
972 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_U);
973 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar)
974 WideCharTy = WCharTy;
975 else {
976 // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar).
977 WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType());
978 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +0000979
James Molloy36365542012-05-04 10:55:22 +0000980 WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType());
981
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +0000982 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
983 InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty, BuiltinType::Char16);
984 else // C99
985 Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type());
986
987 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
988 InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty, BuiltinType::Char32);
989 else // C99
990 Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type());
991
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +0000992 // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is
993 // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against
994 // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to
995 // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent
996 // expressions.
997 InitBuiltinType(DependentTy, BuiltinType::Dependent);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000998
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +0000999 // Placeholder type for functions.
1000 InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy, BuiltinType::Overload);
1001
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00001002 // Placeholder type for bound members.
1003 InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy, BuiltinType::BoundMember);
1004
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001005 // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects.
1006 InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy, BuiltinType::PseudoObject);
1007
John McCall31996342011-04-07 08:22:57 +00001008 // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients.
1009 InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy, BuiltinType::UnknownAny);
1010
John McCall8a6b59a2011-10-17 18:09:15 +00001011 // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts.
1012 InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy, BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast);
1013
Eli Friedman34866c72012-08-31 00:14:07 +00001014 // Placeholder type for builtin functions.
1015 InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy, BuiltinType::BuiltinFn);
1016
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001017 // C99 6.2.5p11.
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00001018 FloatComplexTy = getComplexType(FloatTy);
1019 DoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(DoubleTy);
1020 LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001021
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001022 // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001023 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId);
1024 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001025 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001026
1027 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
1028 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1d);
1029 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray);
1030 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dBufferTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer);
1031 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2d);
1032 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray);
1033 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage3dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage3d);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001034
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001035 InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001036 InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001037 }
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001038
1039 // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no
Fariborz Jahanian29898f42012-04-16 21:03:30 +00001040 ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ?
1041 SignedCharTy : BoolTy);
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001042
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00001043 ObjCConstantStringType = QualType();
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00001044
1045 ObjCSuperType = QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001046
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00001047 // void * type
1048 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001049
1050 // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7)
1051 InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy, BuiltinType::NullPtr);
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001052
1053 // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16
1054 InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00001055
1056 // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list.
1057 VaListTagTy = QualType();
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001058}
1059
David Blaikie9c902b52011-09-25 23:23:43 +00001060DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisca0d0cd2010-09-22 14:32:24 +00001061 return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics();
1062}
1063
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +00001064AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1065 AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D];
1066 if (!Result) {
1067 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec));
1068 Result = new (Mem) AttrVec;
1069 }
1070
1071 return *Result;
1072}
1073
1074/// \brief Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration.
1075void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1076 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D);
1077 if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) {
1078 Pos->second->~AttrVec();
1079 DeclAttrs.erase(Pos);
1080 }
1081}
1082
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001083// FIXME: Remove ?
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001084MemberSpecializationInfo *
Douglas Gregor3c74d412009-10-14 20:14:33 +00001085ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001086 assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001087 return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var)
1088 .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>();
1089}
1090
1091ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo
1092ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) {
1093 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos =
1094 TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var);
1095 if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end())
1096 return TemplateOrSpecializationInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001097
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001098 return Pos->second;
1099}
1100
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001101void
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001102ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscdb8b3f2010-07-04 21:44:00 +00001103 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
1104 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001105 assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1106 assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001107 setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo(
1108 Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation));
1109}
1110
1111void
1112ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst,
1113 TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) {
1114 assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] &&
1115 "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from");
1116 TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI;
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001117}
1118
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001119FunctionDecl *ASTContext::getClassScopeSpecializationPattern(
1120 const FunctionDecl *FD){
1121 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1122 llvm::DenseMap<const FunctionDecl*, FunctionDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001123 = ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.find(FD);
1124 if (Pos == ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001125 return nullptr;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001126
1127 return Pos->second;
1128}
1129
1130void ASTContext::setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl *FD,
1131 FunctionDecl *Pattern) {
1132 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1133 assert(Pattern && "Class scope specialization pattern is 0");
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001134 ClassScopeSpecializationPattern[FD] = Pattern;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001135}
1136
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001137NamedDecl *
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001138ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *UUD) {
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001139 llvm::DenseMap<UsingDecl *, NamedDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001140 = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD);
1141 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001142 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001143
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001144 return Pos->second;
1145}
1146
1147void
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001148ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) {
1149 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) ||
1150 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) ||
1151 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) &&
1152 "pattern decl is not a using decl");
1153 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1154 InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1155}
1156
1157UsingShadowDecl *
1158ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) {
1159 llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos
1160 = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst);
1161 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001162 return nullptr;
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001163
1164 return Pos->second;
1165}
1166
1167void
1168ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst,
1169 UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) {
1170 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1171 InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001172}
1173
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001174FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) {
1175 llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos
1176 = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field);
1177 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001178 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001179
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001180 return Pos->second;
1181}
1182
1183void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst,
1184 FieldDecl *Tmpl) {
1185 assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed");
1186 assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed");
1187 assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] &&
1188 "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001189
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001190 InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl;
1191}
1192
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001193ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1194ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1195 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001196 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001197 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001198 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001199
1200 return Pos->second.begin();
1201}
1202
1203ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1204ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1205 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001206 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001207 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001208 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001209
1210 return Pos->second.end();
1211}
1212
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001213unsigned
1214ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1215 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001216 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001217 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1218 return 0;
1219
1220 return Pos->second.size();
1221}
1222
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001223void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method,
1224 const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001225 assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001226 OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden);
1227}
1228
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +00001229void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods(
1230 const NamedDecl *D,
1231 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001232 assert(D);
1233
1234 if (const CXXMethodDecl *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc8e70082013-04-17 00:09:03 +00001235 Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod),
1236 overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001237 return;
1238 }
1239
1240 const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
1241 if (!Method)
1242 return;
1243
Argyrios Kyrtzidis353f6a42012-10-09 18:19:01 +00001244 SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls;
1245 Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa7a10812012-10-09 20:08:43 +00001246 Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end());
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001247}
1248
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +00001249void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) {
1250 assert(!Import->NextLocalImport && "Import declaration already in the chain");
1251 assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration");
1252 if (!FirstLocalImport) {
1253 FirstLocalImport = Import;
1254 LastLocalImport = Import;
1255 return;
1256 }
1257
1258 LastLocalImport->NextLocalImport = Import;
1259 LastLocalImport = Import;
1260}
1261
Chris Lattner53cfe802007-07-18 17:52:12 +00001262//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1263// Type Sizing and Analysis
1264//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001265
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001266/// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified
1267/// scalar floating point type.
1268const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001269 const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001270 assert(BT && "Not a floating point type!");
1271 switch (BT->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001272 default: llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001273 case BuiltinType::Half: return Target->getHalfFormat();
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001274 case BuiltinType::Float: return Target->getFloatFormat();
1275 case BuiltinType::Double: return Target->getDoubleFormat();
1276 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return Target->getLongDoubleFormat();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001277 }
1278}
1279
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001280CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001281 unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth();
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001282
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001283 bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false;
1284 if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) {
1285 Align = AlignFromAttr;
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001286
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001287 // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment
1288 // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases
1289 // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified.
1290 //
Peter Collingbourne2f3cf4b2011-09-29 18:04:28 +00001291 // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001292 // ignore that possibility; Sema should diagnose it.
1293 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) {
1294 UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1295 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1296 } else {
1297 UseAlignAttrOnly = true;
1298 }
1299 }
Fariborz Jahanian9f107182011-05-05 21:19:14 +00001300 else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D))
1301 UseAlignAttrOnly =
1302 D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1303 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001304
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001305 // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything
1306 // else about the declaration and its type.
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001307 if (UseAlignAttrOnly) {
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001308 // do nothing
1309
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001310 } else if (const ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) {
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001311 QualType T = VD->getType();
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001312 if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001313 if (ForAlignof)
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001314 T = RT->getPointeeType();
1315 else
1316 T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType());
1317 }
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001318 QualType BaseT = getBaseElementType(T);
1319 if (!BaseT->isIncompleteType() && !T->isFunctionType()) {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001320 // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the
1321 // large-array alignment on the target.
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001322 if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001323 unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth();
1324 if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) {
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001325 if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType))
1326 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1327 else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) &&
1328 MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType)))
1329 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1330 }
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001331 }
Chad Rosier99ee7822011-07-26 07:03:04 +00001332 Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr()));
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001333 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
1334 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage())
1335 Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1336 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001337 }
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001338
1339 // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if
1340 // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a
1341 // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack). So calculate
1342 // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then
1343 // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type.
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001344 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
1345 const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent();
1346 // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid.
1347 if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) {
1348 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001349
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001350 // Start with the record's overall alignment.
1351 unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001352
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001353 // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record.
1354 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex());
1355 if (Offset > 0) {
1356 // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2,
1357 // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's.
1358 uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1);
1359 if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign)
1360 FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset);
1361 }
1362
1363 Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001364 }
Charles Davis3fc51072010-02-23 04:52:00 +00001365 }
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001366 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001367
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001368 return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align);
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001369}
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001370
John McCallf1249922012-08-21 04:10:00 +00001371// getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in
1372// chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned. This is
1373// the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type
1374// using a trivial copy/move assignment operator.
1375std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1376ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1377 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> sizeAndAlign = getTypeInfoInChars(T);
1378
1379 // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding
1380 // of a base-class subobject. We decide whether that's possible
1381 // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results.
1382 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1383 if (const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1384 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
1385 sizeAndAlign.first = layout.getDataSize();
1386 }
1387 }
1388
1389 return sizeAndAlign;
1390}
1391
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001392/// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits
1393/// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays.
1394std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1395static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context,
1396 const ConstantArrayType *CAT) {
1397 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> EltInfo =
1398 Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType());
1399 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Trieuc7509072013-05-14 23:41:50 +00001400 assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.first.getQuantity()) <=
1401 (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001402 "Overflow in array type char size evaluation");
1403 uint64_t Width = EltInfo.first.getQuantity() * Size;
1404 unsigned Align = EltInfo.second.getQuantity();
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001405 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1406 Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1407 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001408 return std::make_pair(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width),
1409 CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align));
1410}
1411
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001412std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001413ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001414 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1415 return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT);
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001416 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info = getTypeInfo(T);
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001417 return std::make_pair(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.first),
1418 toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.second));
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001419}
1420
1421std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001422ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const {
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001423 return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr());
1424}
1425
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001426std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const {
1427 TypeInfoMap::iterator it = MemoizedTypeInfo.find(T);
1428 if (it != MemoizedTypeInfo.end())
1429 return it->second;
1430
1431 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info = getTypeInfoImpl(T);
1432 MemoizedTypeInfo.insert(std::make_pair(T, Info));
1433 return Info;
1434}
1435
1436/// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits. This
1437/// method does not work on incomplete types.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001438///
1439/// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and
1440/// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this
1441/// should take a QualType, &c.
Chris Lattner4481b422007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001442std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned>
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001443ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const {
Mike Stump5b9a3d52009-02-27 18:32:39 +00001444 uint64_t Width=0;
1445 unsigned Align=8;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001446 switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001447#define TYPE(Class, Base)
1448#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001449#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001450#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
David Blaikieab277d62013-07-13 21:08:03 +00001451#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) \
1452 case Type::Class: \
1453 assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here"); \
1454 return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001455#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
John McCall15547bb2011-06-28 16:49:23 +00001456 llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001457
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001458 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
1459 case Type::FunctionProto:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001460 // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits
1461 Width = 0;
1462 Align = 32;
1463 break;
1464
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001465 case Type::IncompleteArray:
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001466 case Type::VariableArray:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001467 Width = 0;
1468 Align = getTypeAlign(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
1469 break;
1470
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001471 case Type::ConstantArray: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001472 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = cast<ConstantArrayType>(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001473
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001474 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> EltInfo = getTypeInfo(CAT->getElementType());
Abramo Bagnarad541a4c2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001475 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001476 assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.first <= (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
1477 "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation");
Abramo Bagnarad541a4c2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001478 Width = EltInfo.first*Size;
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001479 Align = EltInfo.second;
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001480 if (!getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1481 getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1482 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001483 break;
Christopher Lambc5fafa22007-12-29 05:10:55 +00001484 }
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00001485 case Type::ExtVector:
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001486 case Type::Vector: {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001487 const VectorType *VT = cast<VectorType>(T);
1488 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType());
1489 Width = EltInfo.first*VT->getNumElements();
Eli Friedman3df5efe2008-05-30 09:31:38 +00001490 Align = Width;
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +00001491 // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2.
1492 // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors.
Dan Gohmanef78c8e2010-04-21 23:32:43 +00001493 if (Align & (Align-1)) {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001494 Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align);
1495 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
1496 }
Chad Rosiercc40ea72012-07-13 23:57:43 +00001497 // Adjust the alignment based on the target max.
1498 uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign();
1499 if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align)
1500 Align = TargetVectorAlign;
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001501 break;
1502 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001503
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001504 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001505 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001506 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!");
Chris Lattner4481b422007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001507 case BuiltinType::Void:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001508 // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits.
1509 Width = 0;
1510 Align = 8;
1511 break;
1512
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001513 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001514 Width = Target->getBoolWidth();
1515 Align = Target->getBoolAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001516 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001517 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
1518 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
1519 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001520 case BuiltinType::SChar:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001521 Width = Target->getCharWidth();
1522 Align = Target->getCharAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001523 break;
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00001524 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
1525 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001526 Width = Target->getWCharWidth();
1527 Align = Target->getWCharAlign();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001528 break;
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001529 case BuiltinType::Char16:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001530 Width = Target->getChar16Width();
1531 Align = Target->getChar16Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001532 break;
1533 case BuiltinType::Char32:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001534 Width = Target->getChar32Width();
1535 Align = Target->getChar32Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001536 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001537 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001538 case BuiltinType::Short:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001539 Width = Target->getShortWidth();
1540 Align = Target->getShortAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001541 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001542 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001543 case BuiltinType::Int:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001544 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1545 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001546 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001547 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001548 case BuiltinType::Long:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001549 Width = Target->getLongWidth();
1550 Align = Target->getLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001551 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001552 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001553 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001554 Width = Target->getLongLongWidth();
1555 Align = Target->getLongLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001556 break;
Chris Lattner0a415ec2009-04-30 02:55:13 +00001557 case BuiltinType::Int128:
1558 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
1559 Width = 128;
1560 Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets.
1561 break;
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001562 case BuiltinType::Half:
1563 Width = Target->getHalfWidth();
1564 Align = Target->getHalfAlign();
1565 break;
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001566 case BuiltinType::Float:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001567 Width = Target->getFloatWidth();
1568 Align = Target->getFloatAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001569 break;
1570 case BuiltinType::Double:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001571 Width = Target->getDoubleWidth();
1572 Align = Target->getDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001573 break;
1574 case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001575 Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth();
1576 Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001577 break;
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001578 case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001579 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t)
1580 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); // == sizeof(void*)
Sebastian Redla81b0b72009-05-27 19:34:06 +00001581 break;
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001582 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
1583 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
1584 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001585 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1586 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001587 break;
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001588 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
1589 // Samplers are modeled as integers.
1590 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1591 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
1592 break;
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001593 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001594 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
1595 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
1596 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
1597 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
1598 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
1599 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
1600 // Currently these types are pointers to opaque types.
1601 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1602 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1603 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001604 }
Chris Lattner48f84b82007-07-15 23:46:53 +00001605 break;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00001606 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001607 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1608 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001609 break;
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001610 case Type::BlockPointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001611 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1612 cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001613 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1614 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001615 break;
1616 }
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001617 case Type::LValueReference:
1618 case Type::RValueReference: {
1619 // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go
1620 // the pointer route.
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001621 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1622 cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001623 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1624 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001625 break;
1626 }
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001627 case Type::Pointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001628 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001629 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1630 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001631 break;
1632 }
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001633 case Type::MemberPointer: {
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00001634 const MemberPointerType *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T);
Benjamin Kramer867ea1d2014-03-02 13:01:17 +00001635 std::tie(Width, Align) = ABI->getMemberPointerWidthAndAlign(MPT);
Anders Carlsson32440a02009-05-17 02:06:04 +00001636 break;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001637 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001638 case Type::Complex: {
1639 // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the
1640 // size.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001641 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> EltInfo =
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001642 getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001643 Width = EltInfo.first*2;
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001644 Align = EltInfo.second;
1645 break;
1646 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001647 case Type::ObjCObject:
1648 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr());
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001649 case Type::Adjusted:
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00001650 case Type::Decayed:
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001651 return getTypeInfo(cast<AdjustedType>(T)->getAdjustedType().getTypePtr());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001652 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001653 const ObjCInterfaceType *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T);
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001654 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001655 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001656 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001657 break;
1658 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001659 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001660 case Type::Enum: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001661 const TagType *TT = cast<TagType>(T);
1662
1663 if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
Douglas Gregor7f971892011-04-20 17:29:44 +00001664 Width = 8;
1665 Align = 8;
Chris Lattner572100b2008-08-09 21:35:13 +00001666 break;
1667 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001668
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001669 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT))
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001670 return getTypeInfo(ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType());
1671
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001672 const RecordType *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT);
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001673 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001674 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001675 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Chris Lattner49a953a2007-07-23 22:46:22 +00001676 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001677 }
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001678
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001679 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001680 return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)->
1681 getReplacementType().getTypePtr());
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001682
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001683 case Type::Auto: {
1684 const AutoType *A = cast<AutoType>(T);
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00001685 assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() &&
1686 "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type");
Matt Beaumont-Gay7a24210e2011-02-22 20:00:16 +00001687 return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr());
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001688 }
1689
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00001690 case Type::Paren:
1691 return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr());
1692
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001693 case Type::Typedef: {
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00001694 const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl();
Douglas Gregorf5bae222010-08-27 00:11:28 +00001695 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info
1696 = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001697 // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed
1698 // alignment we have. This violates the GCC documentation (which says that
1699 // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation.
1700 if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment())
1701 Align = AttrAlign;
1702 else
1703 Align = Info.second;
Douglas Gregorf5bae222010-08-27 00:11:28 +00001704 Width = Info.first;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001705 break;
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001706 }
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001707
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00001708 case Type::Elaborated:
1709 return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001710
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00001711 case Type::Attributed:
1712 return getTypeInfo(
1713 cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr());
1714
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001715 case Type::Atomic: {
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001716 // Start with the base type information.
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001717 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info
1718 = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
1719 Width = Info.first;
1720 Align = Info.second;
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001721
1722 // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max
1723 // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more
1724 // favorable to atomic operations:
1725 if (Width != 0 && Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) {
1726 // Round the size up to a power of 2.
1727 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
1728 Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width);
1729
1730 // Set the alignment equal to the size.
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001731 Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width);
1732 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001733 }
1734
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001735 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001736
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001737 assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2");
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001738 return std::make_pair(Width, Align);
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001739}
1740
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001741/// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters.
1742CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const {
1743 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth());
1744}
1745
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001746/// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters.
1747int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const {
1748 return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth();
1749}
1750
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001751/// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters.
1752/// This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001753CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001754 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001755}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001756CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001757 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001758}
1759
Ken Dycka6046ab2010-01-26 17:25:18 +00001760/// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001761/// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001762CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001763 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001764}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001765CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001766 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001767}
1768
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001769/// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified
1770/// type for the current target in bits. This can be different than the ABI
1771/// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance to overalign
1772/// a data type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001773unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const {
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001774 unsigned ABIAlign = getTypeAlign(T);
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001775
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +00001776 if (Target->getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::xcore)
1777 return ABIAlign; // Never overalign on XCore.
1778
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00001779 const TypedefType *TT = T->getAs<TypedefType>();
1780
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001781 // Double and long long should be naturally aligned if possible.
Richard Smithd7e1fe42014-06-10 23:43:44 +00001782 T = T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
David Majnemer1d4db8f2014-02-24 23:43:27 +00001783 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001784 T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr();
1785 if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) ||
Chad Rosierb57321a2012-03-21 20:20:47 +00001786 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
1787 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong))
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00001788 // Don't increase the alignment if an alignment attribute was specified on a
1789 // typedef declaration.
1790 if (!TT || !TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment())
1791 return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T));
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001792
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001793 return ABIAlign;
1794}
1795
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001796/// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given
1797/// to a global variable of the specified type.
1798unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const {
1799 return std::max(getTypeAlign(T), getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1800}
1801
1802/// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that
1803/// should be given to a global variable of the specified type.
1804CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const {
1805 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T));
1806}
1807
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001808/// DeepCollectObjCIvars -
1809/// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in
1810/// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for
1811/// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class
1812/// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known.
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001813///
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001814void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI,
1815 bool leafClass,
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001816 SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const {
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001817 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass())
1818 DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars);
1819 if (!leafClass) {
Aaron Ballman59abbd42014-03-13 21:09:43 +00001820 for (const auto *I : OI->ivars())
1821 Ivars.push_back(I);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00001822 } else {
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001823 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI);
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001824 for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv;
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001825 Iv= Iv->getNextIvar())
1826 Ivars.push_back(Iv);
1827 }
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001828}
1829
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001830/// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and
1831/// those inherited by it.
1832void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl,
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00001833 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001834 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) {
Ted Kremenek0ef508d2010-09-01 01:21:15 +00001835 // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of
1836 // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories.
Aaron Ballmana9f49e32014-03-13 20:55:22 +00001837 for (auto *Proto : OI->all_referenced_protocols()) {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001838 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001839 for (auto *P : Proto->protocols()) {
1840 Protocols.insert(P->getCanonicalDecl());
1841 CollectInheritedProtocols(P, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001842 }
Fariborz Jahanian8e3b9db2010-02-25 18:24:33 +00001843 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001844
1845 // Categories of this Interface.
Aaron Ballman3fe486a2014-03-13 21:23:55 +00001846 for (const auto *Cat : OI->visible_categories())
1847 CollectInheritedProtocols(Cat, Protocols);
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001848
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001849 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass())
1850 while (SD) {
1851 CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols);
1852 SD = SD->getSuperClass();
1853 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001854 } else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) {
Aaron Ballman19a41762014-03-14 12:55:57 +00001855 for (auto *Proto : OC->protocols()) {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001856 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001857 for (const auto *P : Proto->protocols())
1858 CollectInheritedProtocols(P, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001859 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001860 } else if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) {
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001861 for (auto *Proto : OP->protocols()) {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001862 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001863 for (const auto *P : Proto->protocols())
1864 CollectInheritedProtocols(P, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001865 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001866 }
1867}
1868
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001869unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const {
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00001870 unsigned count = 0;
1871 // Count ivars declared in class extension.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +00001872 for (const auto *Ext : OI->known_extensions())
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001873 count += Ext->ivar_size();
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001874
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00001875 // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation. This
1876 // includes synthesized ivars.
1877 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation())
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001878 count += ImplDecl->ivar_size();
1879
Fariborz Jahanian7c809592009-06-04 01:19:09 +00001880 return count;
1881}
1882
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2e809ce2012-02-03 05:58:16 +00001883bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) {
1884 if (!E)
1885 return false;
1886
1887 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
1888 if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true;
1889
1890 if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
1891 E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this,
1892 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
1893 return true;
1894
1895 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
1896 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true;
1897
1898 return false;
1899}
1900
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00001901/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl,or NULL if none exists.
1902ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
1903 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1904 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1905 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1906 return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001907 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00001908}
1909/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or NULL if none exists.
1910ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) {
1911 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1912 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1913 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1914 return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001915 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00001916}
1917
1918/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl.
1919void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD,
1920 ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) {
1921 assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
1922 ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD;
1923}
1924/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl.
1925void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD,
1926 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) {
1927 assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
1928 ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD;
1929}
1930
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001931const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface(
1932 const NamedDecl *ND) const {
1933 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID =
1934 dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001935 return ID;
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001936 if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD =
1937 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001938 return CD->getClassInterface();
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001939 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD =
1940 dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001941 return IMD->getClassInterface();
1942
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001943 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001944}
1945
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001946/// \brief Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl,or NULL if
1947/// none exists.
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00001948Expr *ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInits(const VarDecl*VD) {
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001949 assert(VD && "Passed null params");
1950 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
1951 "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00001952 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl*, Expr*>::iterator
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001953 I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001954 return (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end()) ? cast<Expr>(I->second) : nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001955}
1956
1957/// \brief Set the copy inialization expression of a block var decl.
1958void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInits(VarDecl*VD, Expr* Init) {
1959 assert(VD && Init && "Passed null params");
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001960 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
1961 "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001962 BlockVarCopyInits[VD] = Init;
1963}
1964
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001965TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001966 unsigned DataSize) const {
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00001967 if (!DataSize)
1968 DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T);
1969 else
1970 assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) &&
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001971 "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!");
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00001972
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001973 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo =
1974 (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8);
1975 new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T);
1976 return TInfo;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3f79ad72009-08-19 01:27:32 +00001977}
1978
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001979TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +00001980 SourceLocation L) const {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001981 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T);
Douglas Gregor2d525f02011-01-25 19:13:18 +00001982 DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L);
John McCall3665e002009-10-23 21:14:09 +00001983 return DI;
1984}
1985
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001986const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001987ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001988 return getObjCLayout(D, nullptr);
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001989}
1990
1991const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001992ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout(
1993 const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const {
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001994 return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D);
1995}
1996
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001997//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1998// Type creation/memoization methods
1999//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2000
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002001QualType
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002002ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const {
2003 unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers();
2004 quals.removeFastQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002005
2006 // Check if we've already instantiated this type.
2007 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002008 ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002009 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002010 if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) {
2011 assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals);
2012 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002013 }
2014
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002015 // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type.
2016 QualType canon;
2017 if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2018 SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002019 canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals);
2020 canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002021
2022 // Re-find the insert position.
2023 (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2024 }
2025
2026 ExtQuals *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals);
2027 ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos);
2028 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002029}
2030
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002031QualType
2032ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T, unsigned AddressSpace) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002033 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2034 if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace)
Chris Lattner445fcab2008-02-20 20:55:12 +00002035 return T;
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002036
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002037 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2038 // into one ExtQuals node.
2039 QualifierCollector Quals;
2040 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002041
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002042 // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get
2043 // another one.
2044 assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() &&
2045 "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!");
2046 Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002047
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002048 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Christopher Lamb025b5fb2008-02-04 02:31:56 +00002049}
2050
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002051QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002052 Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const {
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002053 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002054 if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr)
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002055 return T;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002056
John McCall53fa7142010-12-24 02:08:15 +00002057 if (const PointerType *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2058 QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00002059 if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb68215c2009-06-03 17:15:17 +00002060 QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr);
2061 return getPointerType(ResultType);
2062 }
2063 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002064
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002065 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2066 // into one ExtQuals node.
2067 QualifierCollector Quals;
2068 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002069
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002070 // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get
2071 // another one.
2072 assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() &&
2073 "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!");
2074 Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002075
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002076 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002077}
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002078
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002079const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T,
2080 FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) {
2081 if (T->getExtInfo() == Info)
2082 return T;
2083
2084 QualType Result;
2085 if (const FunctionNoProtoType *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002086 Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getReturnType(), Info);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002087 } else {
2088 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T);
2089 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2090 EPI.ExtInfo = Info;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002091 Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002092 }
2093
2094 return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr());
2095}
2096
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002097void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD,
2098 QualType ResultType) {
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002099 FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
2100 while (true) {
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002101 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2102 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002103 FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI));
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002104 if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl())
2105 FD = Next;
2106 else
2107 break;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002108 }
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002109 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
2110 L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002111}
2112
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002113/// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex
2114/// number with the specified element type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002115QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002116 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2117 // structure.
2118 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2119 ComplexType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002120
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002121 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002122 if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2123 return QualType(CT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002124
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002125 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2126 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2127 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002128 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002129 Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002130
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002131 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2132 ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002133 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002134 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002135 ComplexType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002136 Types.push_back(New);
2137 ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2138 return QualType(New, 0);
2139}
2140
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00002141/// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to
2142/// the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002143QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +00002144 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2145 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002146 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002147 PointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002148
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002149 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002150 if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002151 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002152
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002153 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2154 // so fill in the canonical type field.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002155 QualType Canonical;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002156 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002157 Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002158
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002159 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2160 PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002161 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002162 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002163 PointerType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002164 Types.push_back(New);
2165 PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002166 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00002167}
2168
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002169QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedType(QualType Orig, QualType New) const {
2170 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2171 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, Orig, New);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002172 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002173 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2174 if (AT)
2175 return QualType(AT, 0);
2176
2177 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(New);
2178
2179 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2180 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002181 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002182
2183 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2184 AdjustedType(Type::Adjusted, Orig, New, Canonical);
2185 Types.push_back(AT);
2186 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2187 return QualType(AT, 0);
2188}
2189
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002190QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const {
2191 assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay");
2192
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002193 QualType Decayed;
2194
2195 // C99 6.7.5.3p7:
2196 // A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be
2197 // adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type
2198 // qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of
2199 // the array type derivation.
2200 if (T->isArrayType())
2201 Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T);
2202
2203 // C99 6.7.5.3p8:
2204 // A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type"
2205 // shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as
2206 // in 6.3.2.1.
2207 if (T->isFunctionType())
2208 Decayed = getPointerType(T);
2209
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002210 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2211 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, T, Decayed);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002212 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002213 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2214 if (AT)
2215 return QualType(AT, 0);
2216
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002217 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed);
2218
2219 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002220 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002221 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002222
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002223 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecayedType(T, Decayed, Canonical);
2224 Types.push_back(AT);
2225 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2226 return QualType(AT, 0);
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002227}
2228
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002229/// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002230/// a pointer to the specified block.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002231QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const {
Steve Naroff0ac012832008-08-28 19:20:44 +00002232 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only");
2233 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002234 // structure.
2235 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2236 BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002237
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002238 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002239 if (BlockPointerType *PT =
2240 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2241 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002242
2243 // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002244 // type either so fill in the canonical type field.
2245 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002246 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002247 Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002248
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002249 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2250 BlockPointerType *NewIP =
2251 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002252 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002253 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002254 BlockPointerType *New
2255 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical);
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002256 Types.push_back(New);
2257 BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2258 return QualType(New, 0);
2259}
2260
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002261/// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2262/// lvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002263QualType
2264ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const {
Douglas Gregor291e8ee2011-05-21 22:16:50 +00002265 assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy &&
2266 "Unresolved overloaded function type");
2267
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002268 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2269 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002270 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002271 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002272
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002273 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002274 if (LValueReferenceType *RT =
2275 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002276 return QualType(RT, 0);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002277
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002278 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2279
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002280 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2281 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2282 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002283 if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2284 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2285 Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002286
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002287 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002288 LValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2289 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002290 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002291 }
2292
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002293 LValueReferenceType *New
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002294 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical,
2295 SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002296 Types.push_back(New);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002297 LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002298
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002299 return QualType(New, 0);
2300}
2301
2302/// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2303/// rvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002304QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const {
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002305 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2306 // structure.
2307 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002308 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002309
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002310 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002311 if (RValueReferenceType *RT =
2312 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2313 return QualType(RT, 0);
2314
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002315 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2316
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002317 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2318 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2319 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002320 if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2321 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2322 Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002323
2324 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2325 RValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2326 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002327 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002328 }
2329
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002330 RValueReferenceType *New
2331 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002332 Types.push_back(New);
2333 RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002334 return QualType(New, 0);
2335}
2336
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002337/// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a
2338/// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002339QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002340 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2341 // structure.
2342 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2343 MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls);
2344
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002345 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002346 if (MemberPointerType *PT =
2347 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2348 return QualType(PT, 0);
2349
2350 // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2351 // type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2352 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor615ac672009-11-04 16:49:01 +00002353 if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002354 Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls));
2355
2356 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2357 MemberPointerType *NewIP =
2358 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002359 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002360 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002361 MemberPointerType *New
2362 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002363 Types.push_back(New);
2364 MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2365 return QualType(New, 0);
2366}
2367
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002368/// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002369/// array of the specified element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002370QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002371 const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002372 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002373 unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const {
Sebastian Redl2dfdb822009-11-05 15:52:31 +00002374 assert((EltTy->isDependentType() ||
2375 EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) &&
Eli Friedmanbe7e42b2009-05-29 20:17:55 +00002376 "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!");
2377
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002378 // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for
2379 // the target.
2380 llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn);
Jay Foad6d4db0c2010-12-07 08:25:34 +00002381 ArySize =
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00002382 ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(EltTy)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002383
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002384 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002385 ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, EltTy, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002386
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002387 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002388 if (ConstantArrayType *ATP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002389 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002390 return QualType(ATP, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002391
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002392 // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, this won't
2393 // be a canonical type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2394 QualType Canon;
2395 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2396 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002397 Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002398 ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002399 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002400
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002401 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002402 ConstantArrayType *NewIP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002403 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002404 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002405 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002406
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002407 ConstantArrayType *New = new(*this,TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002408 ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002409 ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002410 Types.push_back(New);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002411 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002412}
2413
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002414/// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be
2415/// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known
2416/// sizes replaced with [*].
2417QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const {
2418 // Vastly most common case.
2419 if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002420
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002421 QualType result;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002422
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002423 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002424 const Type *ty = split.Ty;
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002425 switch (ty->getTypeClass()) {
2426#define TYPE(Class, Base)
2427#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
2428#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
2429#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
2430 llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?");
2431
2432 // These types should never be variably-modified.
2433 case Type::Builtin:
2434 case Type::Complex:
2435 case Type::Vector:
2436 case Type::ExtVector:
2437 case Type::DependentSizedExtVector:
2438 case Type::ObjCObject:
2439 case Type::ObjCInterface:
2440 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
2441 case Type::Record:
2442 case Type::Enum:
2443 case Type::UnresolvedUsing:
2444 case Type::TypeOfExpr:
2445 case Type::TypeOf:
2446 case Type::Decltype:
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00002447 case Type::UnaryTransform:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002448 case Type::DependentName:
2449 case Type::InjectedClassName:
2450 case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
2451 case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization:
2452 case Type::TemplateTypeParm:
2453 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack:
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00002454 case Type::Auto:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002455 case Type::PackExpansion:
2456 llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified");
2457
2458 // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to
2459 // further decay.
2460 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
2461 case Type::FunctionProto:
2462 case Type::BlockPointer:
2463 case Type::MemberPointer:
2464 return type;
2465
2466 // These types can be variably-modified. All these modifications
2467 // preserve structure except as noted by comments.
2468 // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op
2469 // optimizations available here.
2470 case Type::Pointer:
2471 result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(
2472 cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType()));
2473 break;
2474
2475 case Type::LValueReference: {
2476 const LValueReferenceType *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty);
2477 result = getLValueReferenceType(
2478 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()),
2479 lv->isSpelledAsLValue());
2480 break;
2481 }
2482
2483 case Type::RValueReference: {
2484 const RValueReferenceType *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty);
2485 result = getRValueReferenceType(
2486 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()));
2487 break;
2488 }
2489
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00002490 case Type::Atomic: {
2491 const AtomicType *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty);
2492 result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType()));
2493 break;
2494 }
2495
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002496 case Type::ConstantArray: {
2497 const ConstantArrayType *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty);
2498 result = getConstantArrayType(
2499 getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()),
2500 cat->getSize(),
2501 cat->getSizeModifier(),
2502 cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
2503 break;
2504 }
2505
2506 case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
2507 const DependentSizedArrayType *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty);
2508 result = getDependentSizedArrayType(
2509 getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()),
2510 dat->getSizeExpr(),
2511 dat->getSizeModifier(),
2512 dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2513 dat->getBracketsRange());
2514 break;
2515 }
2516
2517 // Turn incomplete types into [*] types.
2518 case Type::IncompleteArray: {
2519 const IncompleteArrayType *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty);
2520 result = getVariableArrayType(
2521 getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002522 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002523 ArrayType::Normal,
2524 iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2525 SourceRange());
2526 break;
2527 }
2528
2529 // Turn VLA types into [*] types.
2530 case Type::VariableArray: {
2531 const VariableArrayType *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty);
2532 result = getVariableArrayType(
2533 getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002534 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002535 ArrayType::Star,
2536 vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2537 vat->getBracketsRange());
2538 break;
2539 }
2540 }
2541
2542 // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002543 return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals);
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002544}
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002545
Steve Naroffcadebd02007-08-30 18:14:25 +00002546/// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a
2547/// variable array of the specified element type.
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00002548QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,
2549 Expr *NumElts,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002550 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002551 unsigned IndexTypeQuals,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002552 SourceRange Brackets) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002553 // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's
2554 // that have an expression provided for their size.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002555 QualType Canon;
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002556
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002557 // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type.
2558 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2559 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002560 Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002561 IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002562 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002563 }
2564
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002565 VariableArrayType *New = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002566 VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002567
2568 VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New);
2569 Types.push_back(New);
2570 return QualType(New, 0);
2571}
2572
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002573/// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to
2574/// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element
Douglas Gregorf3f95522009-07-31 00:23:35 +00002575/// type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002576QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,
2577 Expr *numElements,
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002578 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002579 unsigned elementTypeQuals,
2580 SourceRange brackets) const {
2581 assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() ||
2582 numElements->isValueDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002583 "Size must be type- or value-dependent!");
2584
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002585 // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number
2586 // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent
2587 // initializer. We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay
2588 // because they can't be used in most locations.
2589 if (!numElements) {
2590 DependentSizedArrayType *newType
2591 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2592 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(),
2593 numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2594 brackets);
2595 Types.push_back(newType);
2596 return QualType(newType, 0);
2597 }
2598
2599 // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we
2600 // also build a canonical type.
2601
2602 SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
2603
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002604 void *insertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002605 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002606 DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this,
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002607 QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002608 ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002609
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002610 // Look for an existing type with these properties.
2611 DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy =
2612 DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002613
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002614 // If we don't have one, build one.
2615 if (!canonTy) {
2616 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002617 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002618 QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2619 brackets);
2620 DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
2621 Types.push_back(canonTy);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002622 }
2623
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002624 // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array.
2625 QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0),
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002626 canonElementType.Quals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002627
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002628 // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type,
2629 // then just use that as our result.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002630 if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType)
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002631 return canon;
2632
2633 // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling
2634 // of the element type.
2635 DependentSizedArrayType *sugaredType
2636 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2637 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements,
2638 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets);
2639 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
2640 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002641}
2642
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002643QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002644 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002645 unsigned elementTypeQuals) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002646 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002647 IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002648
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002649 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002650 if (IncompleteArrayType *iat =
2651 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos))
2652 return QualType(iat, 0);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002653
2654 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002655 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. We also have to pull
2656 // qualifiers off the element type.
2657 QualType canon;
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002658
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002659 if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2660 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002661 canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002662 ASM, elementTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002663 canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002664
2665 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002666 IncompleteArrayType *existing =
2667 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2668 assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing;
Ted Kremenek843ebedd2007-10-29 23:37:31 +00002669 }
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002670
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002671 IncompleteArrayType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2672 IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002673
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002674 IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
2675 Types.push_back(newType);
2676 return QualType(newType, 0);
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002677}
2678
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002679/// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of
2680/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
John Thompson22334602010-02-05 00:12:22 +00002681QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002682 VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002683 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002684
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002685 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2686 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002687 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind);
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002688
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002689 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002690 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2691 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2692
2693 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2694 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2695 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00002696 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Bob Wilson77954802010-11-16 00:32:20 +00002697 Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002698
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002699 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2700 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002701 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002702 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002703 VectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002704 VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind);
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002705 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2706 Types.push_back(New);
2707 return QualType(New, 0);
2708}
2709
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002710/// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002711/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002712QualType
2713ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const {
Douglas Gregor39c02722011-06-15 16:02:29 +00002714 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002715
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002716 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2717 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002718 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002719 VectorType::GenericVector);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002720 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002721 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2722 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2723
2724 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2725 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2726 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002727 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002728 Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002729
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002730 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2731 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002732 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002733 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002734 ExtVectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2735 ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical);
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002736 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2737 Types.push_back(New);
2738 return QualType(New, 0);
2739}
2740
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002741QualType
2742ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
2743 Expr *SizeExpr,
2744 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002745 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002746 DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType),
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002747 SizeExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002748
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002749 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002750 DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon
2751 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2752 DependentSizedExtVectorType *New;
2753 if (Canon) {
2754 // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as
2755 // the canonical type for a newly-built type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002756 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2757 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0),
2758 SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002759 } else {
2760 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType);
2761 if (CanonVecTy == vecType) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002762 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2763 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr,
2764 AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002765
2766 DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck
2767 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2768 assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken");
2769 (void)CanonCheck;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002770 DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2771 } else {
2772 QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
2773 SourceLocation());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002774 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2775 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002776 }
2777 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002778
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00002779 Types.push_back(New);
2780 return QualType(New, 0);
2781}
2782
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002783/// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'.
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002784///
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002785QualType
2786ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,
2787 const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const {
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002788 const CallingConv CallConv = Info.getCC();
2789
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002790 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2791 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002792 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00002793 FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002794
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002795 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002796 if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002797 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002798 return QualType(FT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002799
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002800 QualType Canonical;
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002801 if (!ResultTy.isCanonical()) {
2802 Canonical = getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalType(ResultTy), Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002803
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002804 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002805 FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP =
2806 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002807 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002808 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002809
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002810 FunctionProtoType::ExtInfo newInfo = Info.withCallingConv(CallConv);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002811 FunctionNoProtoType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002812 FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, newInfo);
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002813 Types.push_back(New);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002814 FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002815 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002816}
2817
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002818/// \brief Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function.
2819static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) {
2820 return T.isCanonical() &&
2821 (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None ||
2822 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone);
2823}
2824
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002825QualType
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002826ASTContext::getFunctionType(QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002827 const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI) const {
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002828 size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size();
2829
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002830 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2831 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002832 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002833 FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI,
2834 *this);
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00002835
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002836 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002837 if (FunctionProtoType *FTP =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002838 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002839 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002840
2841 // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not.
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002842 bool isCanonical =
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002843 EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_None && isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) &&
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002844 !EPI.HasTrailingReturn;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002845 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002846 if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam())
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002847 isCanonical = false;
2848
2849 // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it.
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002850 // The exception spec is not part of the canonical type.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002851 QualType Canonical;
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002852 if (!isCanonical) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00002853 SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002854 CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
2855 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002856 CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i]));
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002857
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002858 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI;
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002859 CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
Sebastian Redl7c6c9e92011-03-06 10:52:04 +00002860 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpecType = EST_None;
2861 CanonicalEPI.NumExceptions = 0;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002862
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002863 // Result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers.
2864 QualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalType(ResultTy);
2865 if (ResultTy.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) {
2866 Qualifiers Qs = CanResultTy.getQualifiers();
2867 Qs.removeObjCLifetime();
2868 CanResultTy = getQualifiedType(CanResultTy.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2869 }
2870
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002871 Canonical = getFunctionType(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002872
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00002873 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002874 FunctionProtoType *NewIP =
2875 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002876 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002877 }
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002878
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002879 // FunctionProtoType objects are allocated with extra bytes after
2880 // them for three variable size arrays at the end:
2881 // - parameter types
2882 // - exception types
2883 // - consumed-arguments flags
2884 // Instead of the exception types, there could be a noexcept
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002885 // expression, or information used to resolve the exception
2886 // specification.
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002887 size_t Size = sizeof(FunctionProtoType) +
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002888 NumArgs * sizeof(QualType);
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002889 if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Dynamic) {
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002890 Size += EPI.NumExceptions * sizeof(QualType);
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002891 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_ComputedNoexcept) {
Sebastian Redl31ad7542011-03-13 17:09:40 +00002892 Size += sizeof(Expr*);
Richard Smithf623c962012-04-17 00:58:00 +00002893 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Uninstantiated) {
Richard Smithd3729422012-04-19 00:08:28 +00002894 Size += 2 * sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002895 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Unevaluated) {
2896 Size += sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002897 }
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00002898 if (EPI.ConsumedParameters)
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002899 Size += NumArgs * sizeof(bool);
2900
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002901 FunctionProtoType *FTP = (FunctionProtoType*) Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002902 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002903 new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002904 Types.push_back(FTP);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002905 FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002906 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002907}
Chris Lattneref51c202006-11-10 07:17:23 +00002908
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002909#ifndef NDEBUG
2910static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) {
2911 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false;
2912 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
2913 if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD))
2914 return true;
2915 if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() &&
2916 !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD))
2917 return true;
2918 return false;
2919}
2920#endif
2921
2922/// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the
2923/// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration.
2924QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002925 QualType TST) const {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002926 assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl));
2927 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) {
2928 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002929 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002930 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type");
2931 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
2932 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
2933 } else {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002934 Type *newType =
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00002935 new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002936 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2937 Types.push_back(newType);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002938 }
2939 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2940}
2941
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002942/// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
2943/// specified type declaration.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002944QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis89656d22008-10-16 16:50:47 +00002945 assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002946 assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002947
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002948 if (const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl))
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002949 return getTypedefType(Typedef);
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002950
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002951 assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) &&
2952 "Template type parameter types are always available.");
2953
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002954 if (const RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00002955 assert(Record->isFirstDecl() && "struct/union has previous declaration");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002956 assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002957 return getRecordType(Record);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002958 } else if (const EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00002959 assert(Enum->isFirstDecl() && "enum has previous declaration");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002960 return getEnumType(Enum);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002961 } else if (const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Using =
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00002962 dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002963 Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using);
2964 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2965 Types.push_back(newType);
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00002966 } else
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002967 llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00002968
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00002969 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002970}
2971
Chris Lattner32d920b2007-01-26 02:01:53 +00002972/// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002973/// specified typedef name decl.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00002974QualType
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002975ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
2976 QualType Canonical) const {
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002977 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002978
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00002979 if (Canonical.isNull())
2980 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002981 TypedefType *newType = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002982 TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Canonical);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002983 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2984 Types.push_back(newType);
2985 return QualType(newType, 0);
Chris Lattnerd0342e52006-11-20 04:02:15 +00002986}
2987
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002988QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002989 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2990
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002991 if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002992 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
2993 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2994
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002995 RecordType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl);
2996 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2997 Types.push_back(newType);
2998 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002999}
3000
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003001QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003002 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3003
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003004 if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003005 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3006 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3007
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003008 EnumType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl);
3009 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3010 Types.push_back(newType);
3011 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003012}
3013
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003014QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(AttributedType::Kind attrKind,
3015 QualType modifiedType,
3016 QualType equivalentType) {
3017 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id;
3018 AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3019
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003020 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003021 AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos);
3022 if (type) return QualType(type, 0);
3023
3024 QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType);
3025 type = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3026 AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3027
3028 Types.push_back(type);
3029 AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos);
3030
3031 return QualType(type, 0);
3032}
3033
3034
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003035/// \brief Retrieve a substitution-result type.
3036QualType
3037ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003038 QualType Replacement) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00003039 assert(Replacement.isCanonical()
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003040 && "replacement types must always be canonical");
3041
3042 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3043 SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003044 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003045 SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm
3046 = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3047
3048 if (!SubstParm) {
3049 SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3050 SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement);
3051 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3052 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3053 }
3054
3055 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3056}
3057
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003058/// \brief Retrieve a
3059QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(
3060 const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
3061 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) {
3062#ifndef NDEBUG
3063 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator P = ArgPack.pack_begin(),
3064 PEnd = ArgPack.pack_end();
3065 P != PEnd; ++P) {
3066 assert(P->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type");
3067 assert(P->getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type");
3068 }
3069#endif
3070
3071 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3072 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003073 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003074 if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3075 = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3076 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3077
3078 QualType Canon;
3079 if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
3080 Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0));
3081 Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon),
3082 ArgPack);
3083 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3084 }
3085
3086 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3087 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon,
3088 ArgPack);
3089 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3090 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3091 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3092}
3093
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003094/// \brief Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003095/// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally)
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003096/// name.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003097QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index,
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003098 bool ParameterPack,
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003099 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const {
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003100 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003101 TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003102 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003103 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003104 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3105
3106 if (TypeParm)
3107 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003108
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003109 if (TTPDecl) {
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003110 QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003111 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003112
3113 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck
3114 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3115 assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken");
3116 (void)TypeCheck;
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003117 } else
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003118 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3119 TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003120
3121 Types.push_back(TypeParm);
3122 TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos);
3123
3124 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3125}
3126
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003127TypeSourceInfo *
3128ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,
3129 SourceLocation NameLoc,
3130 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003131 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003132 assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3133 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003134 QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003135
3136 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST);
David Blaikie6adc78e2013-02-18 22:06:02 +00003137 TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL =
3138 DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>();
Abramo Bagnara48c05be2012-02-06 14:41:24 +00003139 TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003140 TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc);
3141 TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc());
3142 TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc());
3143 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i)
3144 TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo());
3145 return DI;
3146}
3147
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003148QualType
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003149ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003150 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003151 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003152 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3153 "No dependent template names here!");
3154
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003155 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
3156
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003157 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec;
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003158 ArgVec.reserve(NumArgs);
3159 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
3160 ArgVec.push_back(Args[i].getArgument());
3161
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00003162 return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003163 Underlying);
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003164}
3165
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003166#ifndef NDEBUG
3167static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(const TemplateArgument *Args,
3168 unsigned NumArgs) {
3169 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3170 if (Args[I].isPackExpansion())
3171 return true;
3172
3173 return true;
3174}
3175#endif
3176
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003177QualType
3178ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003179 const TemplateArgument *Args,
3180 unsigned NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003181 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003182 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3183 "No dependent template names here!");
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003184 // Look through qualified template names.
3185 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3186 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003187
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003188 bool IsTypeAlias =
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003189 Template.getAsTemplateDecl() &&
3190 isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl());
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003191 QualType CanonType;
3192 if (!Underlying.isNull())
3193 CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
3194 else {
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003195 // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains
3196 // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack.
3197 assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args, NumArgs)) &&
3198 "Caller must compute aliased type");
3199 IsTypeAlias = false;
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003200 CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args,
3201 NumArgs);
3202 }
Douglas Gregord56a91e2009-02-26 22:19:44 +00003203
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003204 // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't
3205 // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that
3206 // we don't unique and don't want to lose.
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003207 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3208 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs +
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003209 (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0),
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003210 TypeAlignment);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003211 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003212 = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, NumArgs, CanonType,
3213 IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003214
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003215 Types.push_back(Spec);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003216 return QualType(Spec, 0);
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003217}
3218
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003219QualType
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003220ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
3221 const TemplateArgument *Args,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003222 unsigned NumArgs) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003223 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3224 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003225
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003226 // Look through qualified template names.
3227 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3228 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003229
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003230 // Build the canonical template specialization type.
3231 TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template);
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003232 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003233 CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3234 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3235 CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]));
3236
3237 // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already
3238 // exists.
3239 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3240 TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate,
3241 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs, *this);
3242
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003243 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003244 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3245 = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3246
3247 if (!Spec) {
3248 // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type.
3249 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3250 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3251 TypeAlignment);
3252 Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate,
3253 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003254 QualType(), QualType());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003255 Types.push_back(Spec);
3256 TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos);
3257 }
3258
3259 assert(Spec->isDependentType() &&
3260 "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type");
3261 return QualType(Spec, 0);
3262}
3263
3264QualType
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003265ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3266 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003267 QualType NamedType) const {
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003268 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003269 ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003270
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003271 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003272 ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003273 if (T)
3274 return QualType(T, 0);
3275
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003276 QualType Canon = NamedType;
3277 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3278 Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003279 ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3280 assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken");
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003281 (void)CheckT;
3282 }
3283
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003284 T = new (*this) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003285 Types.push_back(T);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003286 ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003287 return QualType(T, 0);
3288}
3289
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003290QualType
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003291ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const {
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003292 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3293 ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType);
3294
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003295 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003296 ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3297 if (T)
3298 return QualType(T, 0);
3299
3300 QualType Canon = InnerType;
3301 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3302 Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType);
3303 ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3304 assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken");
3305 (void)CheckT;
3306 }
3307
3308 T = new (*this) ParenType(InnerType, Canon);
3309 Types.push_back(T);
3310 ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3311 return QualType(T, 0);
3312}
3313
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003314QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3315 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3316 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003317 QualType Canon) const {
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003318 if (Canon.isNull()) {
3319 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003320 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3321 if (Keyword == ETK_None)
3322 CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3323
3324 if (CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword)
3325 Canon = getDependentNameType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003326 }
3327
3328 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003329 DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003330
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003331 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003332 DependentNameType *T
3333 = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003334 if (T)
3335 return QualType(T, 0);
3336
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003337 T = new (*this) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003338 Types.push_back(T);
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003339 DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003340 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003341}
3342
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003343QualType
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003344ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3345 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003346 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003347 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003348 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const {
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003349 // TODO: avoid this copy
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003350 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003351 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I)
3352 ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument());
3353 return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name,
3354 ArgCopy.size(),
3355 ArgCopy.data());
3356}
3357
3358QualType
3359ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3360 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3361 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3362 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
3363 unsigned NumArgs,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003364 const TemplateArgument *Args) const {
Douglas Gregor6e068012011-02-28 00:04:36 +00003365 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
3366 "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003367
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003368 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003369 DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS,
3370 Name, NumArgs, Args);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003371
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003372 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003373 DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T
3374 = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003375 if (T)
3376 return QualType(T, 0);
3377
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003378 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003379
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003380 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3381 if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3382
3383 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003384 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003385 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) {
3386 CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]);
3387 if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I]))
3388 AnyNonCanonArgs = true;
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003389 }
3390
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003391 QualType Canon;
3392 if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) {
3393 Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS,
3394 Name, NumArgs,
3395 CanonArgs.data());
3396
3397 // Find the insert position again.
3398 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3399 }
3400
3401 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) +
3402 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3403 TypeAlignment);
John McCall773cc982010-06-11 11:07:21 +00003404 T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003405 Name, NumArgs, Args, Canon);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003406 Types.push_back(T);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003407 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003408 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003409}
3410
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003411QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,
David Blaikie05785d12013-02-20 22:23:23 +00003412 Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) {
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003413 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003414 PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003415
3416 assert(Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() &&
3417 "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs");
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003418 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003419 PackExpansionType *T
3420 = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3421 if (T)
3422 return QualType(T, 0);
3423
3424 QualType Canon;
3425 if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) {
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003426 Canon = getCanonicalType(Pattern);
3427 // The canonical type might not contain an unexpanded parameter pack, if it
3428 // contains an alias template specialization which ignores one of its
3429 // parameters.
3430 if (Canon->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) {
3431 Canon = getPackExpansionType(getCanonicalType(Pattern), NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003432
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003433 // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into
3434 // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position.
3435 PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3436 }
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003437 }
3438
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003439 T = new (*this) PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003440 Types.push_back(T);
3441 PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3442 return QualType(T, 0);
3443}
3444
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003445/// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols
3446/// alphabetically.
3447static bool CmpProtocolNames(const ObjCProtocolDecl *LHS,
3448 const ObjCProtocolDecl *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor77324f32008-11-17 14:58:09 +00003449 return LHS->getDeclName() < RHS->getDeclName();
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003450}
3451
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003452static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003453 unsigned NumProtocols) {
3454 if (NumProtocols == 0) return true;
3455
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003456 if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0])
3457 return false;
3458
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003459 for (unsigned i = 1; i != NumProtocols; ++i)
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003460 if (!CmpProtocolNames(Protocols[i-1], Protocols[i]) ||
3461 Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i])
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003462 return false;
3463 return true;
3464}
3465
3466static void SortAndUniqueProtocols(ObjCProtocolDecl **Protocols,
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003467 unsigned &NumProtocols) {
3468 ObjCProtocolDecl **ProtocolsEnd = Protocols+NumProtocols;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003469
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003470 // Sort protocols, keyed by name.
3471 std::sort(Protocols, Protocols+NumProtocols, CmpProtocolNames);
3472
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003473 // Canonicalize.
3474 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NumProtocols; I != N; ++I)
3475 Protocols[I] = Protocols[I]->getCanonicalDecl();
3476
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003477 // Remove duplicates.
3478 ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols, ProtocolsEnd);
3479 NumProtocols = ProtocolsEnd-Protocols;
3480}
3481
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003482QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,
3483 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003484 unsigned NumProtocols) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003485 // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols
3486 // to add, then the interface type will do just fine.
3487 if (!NumProtocols && isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(BaseType))
3488 return BaseType;
3489
3490 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003491 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003492 ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, BaseType, Protocols, NumProtocols);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003493 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003494 if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3495 return QualType(QT, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003496
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003497 // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and
3498 // a sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003499 QualType Canonical;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003500 bool ProtocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(Protocols, NumProtocols);
3501 if (!ProtocolsSorted || !BaseType.isCanonical()) {
3502 if (!ProtocolsSorted) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003503 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> Sorted(Protocols,
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00003504 Protocols + NumProtocols);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003505 unsigned UniqueCount = NumProtocols;
3506
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003507 SortAndUniqueProtocols(&Sorted[0], UniqueCount);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003508 Canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(BaseType),
3509 &Sorted[0], UniqueCount);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003510 } else {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003511 Canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(BaseType),
3512 Protocols, NumProtocols);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003513 }
3514
3515 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003516 ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3517 }
3518
3519 unsigned Size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl);
3520 Size += NumProtocols * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
3521 void *Mem = Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
3522 ObjCObjectTypeImpl *T =
3523 new (Mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(Canonical, BaseType, Protocols, NumProtocols);
3524
3525 Types.push_back(T);
3526 ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3527 return QualType(T, 0);
3528}
3529
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003530/// ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols - Checks that protocols in IC's
3531/// protocol list adopt all protocols in QT's qualified-id protocol
3532/// list.
3533bool ASTContext::ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT,
3534 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC) {
3535 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3536 return false;
3537
3538 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3539 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003540 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003541 if (!IC->ClassImplementsProtocol(Proto, false))
3542 return false;
3543 }
3544 return true;
3545 }
3546 return false;
3547}
3548
3549/// QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols - Checks that protocols in
3550/// QT's qualified-id protocol list adopt all protocols in IDecl's list
3551/// of protocols.
3552bool ASTContext::QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT,
3553 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl) {
3554 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3555 return false;
3556 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3557 if (!OPT)
3558 return false;
3559 if (!IDecl->hasDefinition())
3560 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00003561 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocols;
3562 CollectInheritedProtocols(IDecl, InheritedProtocols);
3563 if (InheritedProtocols.empty())
3564 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00003565 // Check that if every protocol in list of id<plist> conforms to a protcol
3566 // of IDecl's, then bridge casting is ok.
3567 bool Conforms = false;
3568 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
3569 Conforms = false;
3570 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
3571 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(Proto, PI)) {
3572 Conforms = true;
3573 break;
3574 }
3575 }
3576 if (!Conforms)
3577 break;
3578 }
3579 if (Conforms)
3580 return true;
3581
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003582 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003583 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
3584 bool Adopts = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003585 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00003586 // return 'true' if 'PI' is in the inheritance hierarchy of Proto
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003587 if ((Adopts = ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(PI, Proto)))
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003588 break;
3589 }
3590 if (!Adopts)
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00003591 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003592 }
3593 return true;
3594}
3595
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003596/// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for
3597/// the given object type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003598QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003599 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3600 ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT);
3601
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003602 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003603 if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT =
3604 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3605 return QualType(QT, 0);
3606
3607 // Find the canonical object type.
3608 QualType Canonical;
3609 if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) {
3610 Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT));
3611
3612 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003613 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3614 }
3615
Douglas Gregorf85bee62010-02-08 22:59:26 +00003616 // No match.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003617 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment);
3618 ObjCObjectPointerType *QType =
3619 new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003620
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003621 Types.push_back(QType);
3622 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003623 return QualType(QType, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003624}
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003625
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003626/// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3627/// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional.
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003628QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl,
3629 ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const {
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003630 if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
3631 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003632
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003633 if (PrevDecl) {
3634 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl");
3635 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3636 return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3637 }
3638
Douglas Gregor7671e532011-12-16 16:34:57 +00003639 // Prefer the definition, if there is one.
3640 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition())
3641 Decl = Def;
3642
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003643 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment);
3644 ObjCInterfaceType *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
3645 Decl->TypeForDecl = T;
3646 Types.push_back(T);
3647 return QualType(T, 0);
Fariborz Jahanian70e8f102007-10-11 00:55:41 +00003648}
3649
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003650/// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique
3651/// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example,
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003652/// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003653/// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003654/// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003655QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003656 TypeOfExprType *toe;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003657 if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
3658 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3659 DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003660
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003661 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003662 DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon
3663 = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3664 if (Canon) {
3665 // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent
3666 // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003667 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr,
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003668 QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0));
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00003669 } else {
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003670 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003671 Canon
3672 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr);
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003673 DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
3674 toe = Canon;
3675 }
3676 } else {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003677 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003678 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical);
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003679 }
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003680 Types.push_back(toe);
3681 return QualType(toe, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003682}
3683
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003684/// getTypeOfType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003685/// TypeOfType nodes. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003686/// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003687/// an issue. This doesn't affect the type checker, since it operates
3688/// on canonical types (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003689QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00003690 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003691 TypeOfType *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical);
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003692 Types.push_back(tot);
3693 return QualType(tot, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003694}
3695
Anders Carlssonad6bd352009-06-24 21:24:56 +00003696
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003697/// \brief Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique DecltypeType
3698/// nodes. This would never be helpful, since each such type has its own
3699/// expression, and would not give a significant memory saving, since there
3700/// is an Expr tree under each such type.
Douglas Gregor81495f32012-02-12 18:42:33 +00003701QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003702 DecltypeType *dt;
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003703
3704 // C++11 [temp.type]p2:
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00003705 // If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003706 // unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same
3707 // type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1).
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00003708 if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003709 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3710 DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003711
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003712 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003713 DependentDecltypeType *Canon
3714 = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003715 if (!Canon) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003716 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003717 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003718 DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003719 }
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003720 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3721 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, QualType((DecltypeType *)Canon, 0));
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003722 } else {
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003723 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3724 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003725 }
Anders Carlsson81df7b82009-06-24 19:06:50 +00003726 Types.push_back(dt);
3727 return QualType(dt, 0);
3728}
3729
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00003730/// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory
3731/// savings are minimal and these are rare.
3732QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,
3733 QualType UnderlyingType,
3734 UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind)
3735 const {
3736 UnaryTransformType *Ty =
Douglas Gregor6c6e6762011-05-25 17:51:54 +00003737 new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType, UnderlyingType,
3738 Kind,
3739 UnderlyingType->isDependentType() ?
Peter Collingbourne15d48ec2012-03-05 16:02:06 +00003740 QualType() : getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00003741 Types.push_back(Ty);
3742 return QualType(Ty, 0);
3743}
3744
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003745/// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been
3746/// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the
3747/// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type.
3748QualType ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, bool IsDecltypeAuto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003749 bool IsDependent) const {
3750 if (DeducedType.isNull() && !IsDecltypeAuto && !IsDependent)
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003751 return getAutoDeductType();
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003752
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003753 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003754 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003755 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003756 AutoType::Profile(ID, DeducedType, IsDecltypeAuto, IsDependent);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003757 if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3758 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003759
Richard Smith74aeef52013-04-26 16:15:35 +00003760 AutoType *AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(DeducedType,
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00003761 IsDecltypeAuto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003762 IsDependent);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003763 Types.push_back(AT);
3764 if (InsertPos)
3765 AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
3766 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00003767}
3768
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003769/// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for
3770/// the given value type.
3771QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const {
3772 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
3773 // structure.
3774 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3775 AtomicType::Profile(ID, T);
3776
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003777 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003778 if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3779 return QualType(AT, 0);
3780
3781 // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3782 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3783 QualType Canonical;
3784 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
3785 Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T));
3786
3787 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3788 AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003789 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003790 }
3791 AtomicType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical);
3792 Types.push_back(New);
3793 AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3794 return QualType(New, 0);
3795}
3796
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00003797/// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'.
3798QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const {
3799 if (AutoDeductTy.isNull())
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003800 AutoDeductTy = QualType(
3801 new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(QualType(), /*decltype(auto)*/false,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003802 /*dependent*/false),
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003803 0);
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00003804 return AutoDeductTy;
3805}
3806
3807/// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'.
3808QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const {
3809 if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull())
3810 AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType());
3811 assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern");
3812 return AutoRRefDeductTy;
3813}
3814
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003815/// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3816/// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003817QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const {
Ted Kremenek2b0ce112007-11-26 21:16:01 +00003818 assert (Decl);
Mike Stumpb93185d2009-08-07 18:05:12 +00003819 // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting
3820 // away const? mutable?
3821 return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl));
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003822}
3823
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003824/// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result
3825/// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and
3826/// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>.
Anders Carlsson22f443f2009-12-12 00:26:23 +00003827CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00003828 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType());
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00003829}
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003830
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00003831/// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
3832CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const {
3833 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType());
3834}
3835
3836/// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
3837CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const {
3838 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType());
3839}
3840
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00003841/// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t".
3842/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
3843QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const {
3844 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
3845 return WCharTy;
3846}
3847
3848/// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t".
3849/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
3850QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const {
3851 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
3852 return UnsignedIntTy;
3853}
3854
Enea Zaffanellaf11ceb62013-01-26 17:08:37 +00003855QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const {
3856 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType());
3857}
3858
3859QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const {
3860 return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType());
3861}
3862
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00003863/// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17)
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00003864/// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9).
3865QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00003866 return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0));
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00003867}
3868
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00003869/// \brief Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in
3870/// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork().
3871QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const {
3872 return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType());
3873}
3874
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00003875//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3876// Type Operators
3877//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3878
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003879CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const {
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003880 // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining
3881 // qualifiers.
3882 T = getCanonicalType(T);
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003883 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003884 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003885 QualType Result;
3886 if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
3887 Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0));
3888 } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) {
3889 Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0));
3890 } else {
3891 Result = QualType(Ty, 0);
3892 }
3893
3894 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result);
3895}
3896
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003897QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,
3898 Qualifiers &quals) {
3899 SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType();
3900
3901 // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to
3902 // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor.
3903 // We then have to strip that sugar back off with
3904 // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly.
3905 const ArrayType *AT =
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003906 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003907
3908 // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType.
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003909 if (!AT) {
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003910 quals = splitType.Quals;
3911 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003912 }
3913
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003914 // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type.
3915 QualType elementType = AT->getElementType();
3916 QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals);
3917
3918 // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we
3919 // can just use the results in splitType.
3920 if (elementType == unqualElementType) {
3921 assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003922 quals = splitType.Quals;
3923 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003924 }
3925
3926 // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then
3927 // build the type back up.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003928 quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003929
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003930 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003931 return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003932 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
3933 }
3934
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003935 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003936 return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003937 }
3938
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003939 if (const VariableArrayType *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003940 return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00003941 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003942 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
3943 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
3944 VAT->getBracketsRange());
3945 }
3946
3947 const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003948 return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003949 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0,
3950 SourceRange());
3951}
3952
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003953/// UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes - If T1 and T2 are pointer types that
3954/// may be similar (C++ 4.4), replaces T1 and T2 with the type that
3955/// they point to and return true. If T1 and T2 aren't pointer types
3956/// or pointer-to-member types, or if they are not similar at this
3957/// level, returns false and leaves T1 and T2 unchanged. Top-level
3958/// qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored. This function will typically
3959/// be called in a loop that successively "unwraps" pointer and
3960/// pointer-to-member types to compare them at each level.
3961bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) {
3962 const PointerType *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>(),
3963 *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>();
3964 if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) {
3965 T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType();
3966 T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType();
3967 return true;
3968 }
3969
3970 const MemberPointerType *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
3971 *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3972 if (T1MPType && T2MPType &&
3973 hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0),
3974 QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) {
3975 T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType();
3976 T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType();
3977 return true;
3978 }
3979
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00003980 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003981 const ObjCObjectPointerType *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
3982 *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3983 if (T1OPType && T2OPType) {
3984 T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType();
3985 T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType();
3986 return true;
3987 }
3988 }
3989
3990 // FIXME: Block pointers, too?
3991
3992 return false;
3993}
3994
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003995DeclarationNameInfo
3996ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,
3997 SourceLocation NameLoc) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003998 switch (Name.getKind()) {
3999 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4000 case TemplateName::Template:
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004001 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004002 return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(),
4003 NameLoc);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004004
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004005 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: {
4006 OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate();
4007 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
4008 return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
4009 }
4010
4011 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4012 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004013 DeclarationName DName;
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004014 if (DTN->isIdentifier()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004015 DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier());
4016 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004017 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004018 DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator());
4019 // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations?
4020 DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc;
4021 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4022 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4023 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004024 }
4025 }
4026
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004027 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4028 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4029 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4030 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(),
4031 NameLoc);
4032 }
4033
4034 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4035 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4036 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4037 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(),
4038 NameLoc);
4039 }
4040 }
4041
4042 llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!");
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004043}
4044
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004045TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004046 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4047 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4048 case TemplateName::Template: {
4049 TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004050 if (TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004051 = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template))
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004052 Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP);
4053
4054 // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6b7e3762009-07-18 00:34:25 +00004055 return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl()));
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004056 }
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004057
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004058 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
4059 llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize overloaded template");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004060
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004061 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4062 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
4063 assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls.");
4064 return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName;
4065 }
4066
4067 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4068 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4069 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4070 return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement());
4071 }
4072
4073 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4074 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4075 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4076 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter
4077 = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack());
4078 TemplateArgument canonArgPack
4079 = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack());
4080 return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack);
4081 }
4082 }
4083
4084 llvm_unreachable("bad template name!");
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004085}
4086
Douglas Gregoradee3e32009-11-11 23:06:43 +00004087bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) {
4088 X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X);
4089 Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y);
4090 return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer();
4091}
4092
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004093TemplateArgument
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004094ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const {
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004095 switch (Arg.getKind()) {
4096 case TemplateArgument::Null:
4097 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004098
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004099 case TemplateArgument::Expression:
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004100 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004101
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004102 case TemplateArgument::Declaration: {
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004103 ValueDecl *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
4104 return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.isDeclForReferenceParam());
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004105 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004106
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004107 case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
4108 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()),
4109 /*isNullPtr*/true);
4110
Douglas Gregor9167f8b2009-11-11 01:00:40 +00004111 case TemplateArgument::Template:
4112 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate()));
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004113
4114 case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
4115 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(
4116 Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()),
Douglas Gregore1d60df2011-01-14 23:41:42 +00004117 Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions());
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004118
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004119 case TemplateArgument::Integral:
Benjamin Kramer6003ad52012-06-07 15:09:51 +00004120 return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004121
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004122 case TemplateArgument::Type:
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00004123 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004124
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004125 case TemplateArgument::Pack: {
Douglas Gregor0192c232010-12-20 16:52:59 +00004126 if (Arg.pack_size() == 0)
4127 return Arg;
4128
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00004129 TemplateArgument *CanonArgs
4130 = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()];
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004131 unsigned Idx = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004132 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(),
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004133 AEnd = Arg.pack_end();
4134 A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx)
4135 CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004136
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00004137 return TemplateArgument(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size());
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004138 }
4139 }
4140
4141 // Silence GCC warning
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004142 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind");
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004143}
4144
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004145NestedNameSpecifier *
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004146ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004147 if (!NNS)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004148 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004149
4150 switch (NNS->getKind()) {
4151 case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
4152 // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004153 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this,
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004154 getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()),
4155 NNS->getAsIdentifier());
4156
4157 case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
4158 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4159 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004160 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004161 NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace());
4162
4163 case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
4164 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4165 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004166 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004167 NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace()
4168 ->getOriginalNamespace());
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004169
4170 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
4171 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: {
4172 QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004173
4174 // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"),
4175 // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those
4176 // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize
4177 // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name
4178 // types, e.g.,
4179 // typedef typename T::type T1;
4180 // typedef typename T1::type T2;
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004181 if (const DependentNameType *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>())
4182 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(),
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004183 const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004184
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004185 // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec.
4186 // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the
4187 // first place?
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004188 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, false,
4189 const_cast<Type *>(T.getTypePtr()));
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004190 }
4191
4192 case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
4193 // The global specifier is canonical and unique.
4194 return NNS;
4195 }
4196
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004197 llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!");
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004198}
4199
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004200
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004201const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004202 // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004203 if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004204 // Handle the common positive case fast.
4205 if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T))
4206 return AT;
4207 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004208
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004209 // Handle the common negative case fast.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004210 if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004211 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004212
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004213 // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type. This
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004214 // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes
4215 // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type."
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004216
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004217 // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have
4218 // sugar such as a typedef in the way. If we have type qualifiers on the type
Douglas Gregor2211d342009-08-05 05:36:45 +00004219 // we must propagate them down into the element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004220
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004221 SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004222 Qualifiers qs = split.Quals;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004223
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004224 // If we have a simple case, just return now.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004225 const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004226 if (!ATy || qs.empty())
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004227 return ATy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004228
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004229 // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it. Push the
4230 // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004231 QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004232
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004233 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy))
4234 return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(),
4235 CAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004236 CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004237 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy))
4238 return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy,
4239 IAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004240 IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004241
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004242 if (const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004243 = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy))
4244 return cast<ArrayType>(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004245 getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004246 DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004247 DSAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004248 DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004249 DSAT->getBracketsRange()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004250
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004251 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy);
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004252 return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004253 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004254 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004255 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004256 VAT->getBracketsRange()));
Chris Lattnered0d0792008-04-06 22:41:35 +00004257}
4258
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004259QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const {
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00004260 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4261 return getDecayedType(T);
4262 return T;
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004263}
4264
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004265QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004266 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4267 T = getAdjustedParameterType(T);
4268 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4269}
4270
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004271/// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the
4272/// specified array type to a pointer. This operation is non-trivial when
4273/// handling typedefs etc. The canonical type of "T" must be an array type,
4274/// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array.
4275///
4276/// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004277QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004278 // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any
4279 // typedefs in the element type of the array. This also handles propagation
4280 // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present
4281 // (C99 6.7.3p8).
4282 const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty);
4283 assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004284
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004285 QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004286
4287 // int x[restrict 4] -> int *restrict
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004288 return getQualifiedType(PtrTy, PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004289}
4290
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004291QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const {
4292 return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor79f83ed2009-07-23 23:49:00 +00004293}
4294
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004295QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const {
4296 Qualifiers qs;
4297 while (true) {
4298 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004299 const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe();
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004300 if (!array) break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004301
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004302 type = array->getElementType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004303 qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004304 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004305
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004306 return getQualifiedType(type, qs);
Anders Carlssone0808df2008-12-21 03:44:36 +00004307}
4308
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004309/// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004310uint64_t
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004311ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA) const {
4312 uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
4313 do {
4314 ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Smith7808c6a2012-12-06 03:04:50 +00004315 CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>(
4316 CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe());
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004317 } while (CA);
4318 return ElementCount;
4319}
4320
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004321/// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types.
4322/// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float.
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004323static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004324 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004325 return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004326
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004327 assert(T->getAs<BuiltinType>() && "getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
4328 switch (T->getAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004329 default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00004330 case BuiltinType::Half: return HalfRank;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004331 case BuiltinType::Float: return FloatRank;
4332 case BuiltinType::Double: return DoubleRank;
4333 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004334 }
4335}
4336
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004337/// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating
4338/// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize).
Steve Narofffc6ffa22007-08-27 01:41:48 +00004339/// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type.
4340/// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type.
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004341QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size,
4342 QualType Domain) const {
4343 FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size);
4344 if (Domain->isComplexType()) {
4345 switch (EltRank) {
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004346 case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported");
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004347 case FloatRank: return FloatComplexTy;
4348 case DoubleRank: return DoubleComplexTy;
4349 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy;
4350 }
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004351 }
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004352
4353 assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!");
4354 switch (EltRank) {
Joey Goulydd7f4562013-01-23 11:56:20 +00004355 case HalfRank: return HalfTy;
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004356 case FloatRank: return FloatTy;
4357 case DoubleRank: return DoubleTy;
4358 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy;
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004359 }
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004360 llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank");
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004361}
4362
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004363/// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating
4364/// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' ==
4365/// '_Complex double'). If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004366/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004367int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004368 FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS);
4369 FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004370
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004371 if (LHSR == RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004372 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004373 if (LHSR > RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004374 return 1;
4375 return -1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004376}
4377
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004378/// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This
4379/// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum,
4380/// or if it is not canonicalized.
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004381unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00004382 assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized");
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00004383
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004384 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004385 default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer");
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004386 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004387 return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004388 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
4389 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
4390 case BuiltinType::SChar:
4391 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004392 return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004393 case BuiltinType::Short:
4394 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004395 return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004396 case BuiltinType::Int:
4397 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004398 return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004399 case BuiltinType::Long:
4400 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004401 return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004402 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
4403 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004404 return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00004405 case BuiltinType::Int128:
4406 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
4407 return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3);
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004408 }
4409}
4410
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004411/// \brief Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according
4412/// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions).
4413///
4414/// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no
4415/// promotion occurs.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004416QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const {
Douglas Gregore05d3cb2010-05-24 20:13:53 +00004417 if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent())
4418 return QualType();
4419
John McCalld25db7e2013-05-06 21:39:12 +00004420 FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields?
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004421 if (!Field)
4422 return QualType();
4423
4424 QualType FT = Field->getType();
4425
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00004426 uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004427 uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy);
4428 // GCC extension compatibility: if the bit-field size is less than or equal
4429 // to the size of int, it gets promoted no matter what its type is.
4430 // For instance, unsigned long bf : 4 gets promoted to signed int.
4431 if (BitWidth < IntSize)
4432 return IntTy;
4433
4434 if (BitWidth == IntSize)
4435 return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4436
4437 // Types bigger than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act
4438 // like the base type.
4439 // FIXME: This doesn't quite match what gcc does, but what gcc does here
4440 // is ridiculous.
4441 return QualType();
4442}
4443
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004444/// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will
4445/// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable
4446/// integer type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004447QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004448 assert(!Promotable.isNull());
4449 assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType());
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00004450 if (const EnumType *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>())
4451 return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType();
Eli Friedman3f37c1c2011-10-26 07:22:48 +00004452
4453 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
4454 // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t
4455 // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following
4456 // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type:
4457 // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or
4458 // unsigned long long int [...]
4459 // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this?
4460 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S ||
4461 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U ||
4462 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 ||
4463 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) {
4464 bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S;
4465 uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT);
4466 QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy,
4467 LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy };
4468 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) {
4469 uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
4470 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
4471 (FromSize == ToSize &&
4472 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType()))
4473 return PromoteTypes[Idx];
4474 }
4475 llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long");
4476 }
4477 }
4478
4479 // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type.
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004480 if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType())
4481 return IntTy;
Eli Friedman6745c3b2012-11-15 01:21:59 +00004482 uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable);
4483 uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy);
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004484 assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize);
4485 return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4486}
4487
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004488/// \brief Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable
4489/// type and returns its ownership.
4490Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const {
4491 while (!T.isNull()) {
4492 if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None)
4493 return T.getObjCLifetime();
4494 if (T->isArrayType())
4495 T = getBaseElementType(T);
4496 else if (const PointerType *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
4497 T = PT->getPointeeType();
4498 else if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis8e252532011-07-01 23:01:46 +00004499 T = RT->getPointeeType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004500 else
4501 break;
4502 }
4503
4504 return Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4505}
4506
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004507static const Type *getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType *ET) {
4508 // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types.
4509 // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types.
4510 if (ET->getDecl()->isComplete() && !ET->getDecl()->isScoped())
4511 return ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004512 return nullptr;
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004513}
4514
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004515/// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type:
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004516/// C99 6.3.1.8p1. If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004517/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004518int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004519 const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr();
4520 const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr();
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004521
4522 // Unwrap enums to their underlying type.
4523 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(LHSC))
4524 LHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4525 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(RHSC))
4526 RHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4527
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004528 if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004529
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004530 bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
4531 bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004532
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004533 unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC);
4534 unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004535
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004536 if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) { // Both signed or both unsigned.
4537 if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0;
4538 return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1;
4539 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004540
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004541 // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa.
4542 if (LHSUnsigned) {
4543 // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it.
4544 if (LHSRank >= RHSRank)
4545 return 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004546
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004547 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4548 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004549 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004550 return -1;
4551 }
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004552
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004553 // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it.
4554 if (RHSRank >= LHSRank)
4555 return -1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004556
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004557 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4558 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004559 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004560 return 1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004561}
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004562
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004563// getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004564QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const {
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004565 if (!CFConstantStringTypeDecl) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004566 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("NSConstantString");
John McCallae580fe2010-02-05 01:33:36 +00004567 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->startDefinition();
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004568
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004569 QualType FieldTypes[4];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004570
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004571 // const int *isa;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004572 FieldTypes[0] = getPointerType(IntTy.withConst());
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004573 // int flags;
4574 FieldTypes[1] = IntTy;
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004575 // const char *str;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004576 FieldTypes[2] = getPointerType(CharTy.withConst());
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004577 // long length;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004578 FieldTypes[3] = LongTy;
4579
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004580 // Create fields
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004581 for (unsigned i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004582 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTypeDecl,
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +00004583 SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004584 SourceLocation(), nullptr,
4585 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4586 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Richard Smith938f40b2011-06-11 17:19:42 +00004587 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smith2b013182012-06-10 03:12:00 +00004588 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004589 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004590 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->addDecl(Field);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004591 }
4592
Douglas Gregord5058122010-02-11 01:19:42 +00004593 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->completeDefinition();
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004594 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004595
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004596 return getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTypeDecl);
Gabor Greif412af032007-09-11 15:32:40 +00004597}
Anders Carlsson87c149b2007-10-11 01:00:40 +00004598
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00004599QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const {
4600 if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004601 RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("objc_super");
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00004602 TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4603 ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4604 }
4605 return ObjCSuperType;
4606}
4607
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004608void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004609 const RecordType *Rec = T->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004610 assert(Rec && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
4611 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = Rec->getDecl();
4612}
4613
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004614QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004615 if (BlockDescriptorType)
4616 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4617
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004618 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004619 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004620 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor");
4621 RD->startDefinition();
4622
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004623 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4624 UnsignedLongTy,
4625 UnsignedLongTy,
4626 };
4627
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00004628 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004629 "reserved",
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004630 "Size"
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004631 };
4632
4633 for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004634 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4635 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004636 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4637 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004638 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004639 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004640 }
4641
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004642 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004643
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004644 BlockDescriptorType = RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004645
4646 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4647}
4648
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004649QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004650 if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType)
4651 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4652
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004653 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004654 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004655 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose");
4656 RD->startDefinition();
4657
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004658 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4659 UnsignedLongTy,
4660 UnsignedLongTy,
4661 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy),
4662 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy)
4663 };
4664
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00004665 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004666 "reserved",
4667 "Size",
4668 "CopyFuncPtr",
4669 "DestroyFuncPtr"
4670 };
4671
4672 for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004673 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4674 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004675 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4676 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004677 /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004678 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004679 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004680 }
4681
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004682 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004683
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004684 BlockDescriptorExtendedType = RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004685 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4686}
4687
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00004688/// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty"
4689/// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic
4690/// in buildByrefHelpers.
4691bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,
4692 const VarDecl *D) {
4693 if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
4694 const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInits(D);
4695 if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false;
4696
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00004697 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniana00076c2010-11-17 00:21:28 +00004698 }
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00004699
4700 if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false;
4701
4702 Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers();
4703
4704 // If we have lifetime, that dominates.
4705 if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) {
4706 assert(getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
4707
4708 switch (lifetime) {
4709 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible");
4710
4711 // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned.
4712 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
4713 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
4714 return false;
4715
4716 // Tell the runtime that this is ARC __weak, called by the
4717 // byref routines.
4718 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
4719 // ARC __strong __block variables need to be retained.
4720 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
4721 return true;
4722 }
4723 llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!");
4724 }
4725 return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) ||
4726 Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType());
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00004727}
4728
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00004729bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,
4730 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime,
4731 bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const {
4732
4733 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1 ||
4734 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
4735 return false;
4736
4737 HasByrefExtendedLayout = false;
Fariborz Jahanianf762b722012-12-11 19:58:01 +00004738 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00004739 HasByrefExtendedLayout = true;
4740 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4741 }
4742 else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
4743 LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime();
4744 // MRR.
4745 else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
4746 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
4747 else
4748 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4749 return true;
4750}
4751
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00004752TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() {
4753 if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl)
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00004754 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl =
4755 buildImplicitTypedef(getObjCIdType(), "instancetype");
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00004756 return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl;
4757}
4758
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00004759// This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL:
4760// typedef <type> BOOL;
Chris Lattnere0218992007-10-30 20:27:44 +00004761static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) {
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00004762 if (const TypedefType *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
Chris Lattner9b1f2792008-11-24 03:52:59 +00004763 if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
4764 return II->isStr("BOOL");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004765
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00004766 return false;
4767}
4768
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00004769/// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004770/// purpose.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004771CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const {
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004772 if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType())
4773 return CharUnits::Zero();
4774
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004775 CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004776
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004777 // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004778 if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004779 sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy));
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004780 // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in.
4781 else if (type->isArrayType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004782 sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004783 return sz;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004784}
4785
4786static inline
4787std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) {
4788 return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity());
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004789}
4790
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004791/// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004792/// declaration.
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004793std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const {
4794 std::string S;
4795
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004796 const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl();
4797 QualType BlockTy =
4798 Expr->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4799 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00004800 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004801 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(
4802 Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S,
4803 true /*Extended*/);
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00004804 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004805 getObjCEncodingForType(BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004806 // Compute size of all parameters.
4807 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
4808 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
4809 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004810 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
4811 CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize;
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00004812 for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
4813 QualType PType = PI->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004814 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahaniand4879412012-06-30 00:48:59 +00004815 if (sz.isZero())
4816 continue;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004817 assert (sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004818 ParmOffset += sz;
4819 }
4820 // Size of the argument frame
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004821 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004822 // Block pointer and offset.
4823 S += "@?0";
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004824
4825 // Argument types.
4826 ParmOffset = PtrSize;
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00004827 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004828 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
4829 if (const ArrayType *AT =
4830 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4831 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4832 // elements.
4833 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
4834 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4835 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4836 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00004837 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00004838 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType,
4839 S, true /*Extended*/);
4840 else
4841 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004842 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004843 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004844 }
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004845
4846 return S;
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004847}
4848
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004849bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl,
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004850 std::string& S) {
4851 // Encode result type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004852 getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004853 CharUnits ParmOffset;
4854 // Compute size of all parameters.
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00004855 for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
4856 QualType PType = PI->getType();
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004857 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004858 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00004859 continue;
4860
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004861 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004862 "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004863 ParmOffset += sz;
4864 }
4865 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
4866 ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero();
4867
4868 // Argument types.
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00004869 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004870 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
4871 if (const ArrayType *AT =
4872 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4873 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4874 // elements.
4875 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
4876 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4877 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4878 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4879 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
4880 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
4881 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
4882 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004883
4884 return false;
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004885}
4886
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004887/// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single
4888/// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and
4889/// block object types.
4890void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
4891 QualType T, std::string& S,
4892 bool Extended) const {
4893 // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter.
4894 getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S);
4895 // Encode parameter type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004896 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004897 true /*OutermostType*/,
4898 false /*EncodingProperty*/,
4899 false /*StructField*/,
4900 Extended /*EncodeBlockParameters*/,
4901 Extended /*EncodeClassNames*/);
4902}
4903
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00004904/// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004905/// declaration.
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004906bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004907 std::string& S,
4908 bool Extended) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004909 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004910 // Encode return type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004911 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
4912 Decl->getReturnType(), S, Extended);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004913 // Compute size of all parameters.
4914 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
4915 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
4916 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004917 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004918 // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for
4919 // their size.
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004920 CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004921 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00004922 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Chris Lattnera4997152009-02-20 18:43:26 +00004923 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004924 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004925 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00004926 continue;
4927
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004928 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
4929 "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type");
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004930 ParmOffset += sz;
4931 }
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004932 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004933 S += "@0:";
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004934 S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004935
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004936 // Argument types.
4937 ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004938 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00004939 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004940 const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004941 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
Fariborz Jahaniana0befc02008-12-20 23:29:59 +00004942 if (const ArrayType *AT =
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00004943 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4944 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4945 // elements.
Steve Naroff323827e2009-04-14 00:40:09 +00004946 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00004947 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4948 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4949 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004950 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
4951 PType, S, Extended);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004952 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004953 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004954 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004955
4956 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004957}
4958
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00004959ObjCPropertyImplDecl *
4960ASTContext::getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(
4961 const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
4962 const Decl *Container) const {
4963 if (!Container)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004964 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00004965 if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CID =
4966 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) {
Aaron Ballmand85eff42014-03-14 15:02:45 +00004967 for (auto *PID : CID->property_impls())
4968 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
4969 return PID;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004970 } else {
4971 const ObjCImplementationDecl *OID=cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container);
4972 for (auto *PID : OID->property_impls())
4973 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
4974 return PID;
4975 }
4976 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00004977}
4978
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004979/// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00004980/// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004981/// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be
4982/// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004983/// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple
4984/// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The
4985/// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are
4986/// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types
4987/// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00004988/// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration:
4989/// @code
4990/// enum PropertyAttributes {
4991/// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R', // property is read-only.
4992/// kPropertyBycopy = 'C', // property is a copy of the value last assigned
4993/// kPropertyByref = '&', // property is a reference to the value last assigned
4994/// kPropertyDynamic = 'D', // property is dynamic
4995/// kPropertyGetter = 'G', // followed by getter selector name
4996/// kPropertySetter = 'S', // followed by setter selector name
4997/// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V' // followed by instance variable name
Bob Wilson8cf61852012-03-22 17:48:02 +00004998/// kPropertyType = 'T' // followed by old-style type encoding.
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00004999/// kPropertyWeak = 'W' // 'weak' property
5000/// kPropertyStrong = 'P' // property GC'able
5001/// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N' // property non-atomic
5002/// };
5003/// @endcode
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005004void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005005 const Decl *Container,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005006 std::string& S) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005007 // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s).
5008 bool Dynamic = false;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005009 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = nullptr;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005010
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005011 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropertyImpDecl =
5012 getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(PD, Container)) {
5013 if (PropertyImpDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
5014 Dynamic = true;
5015 else
5016 SynthesizePID = PropertyImpDecl;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005017 }
5018
5019 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
5020 S = "T";
5021
5022 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005023 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5024 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005025 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PD->getType(), S, true, true, nullptr,
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005026 true /* outermost type */,
5027 true /* encoding for property */);
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005028
5029 if (PD->isReadOnly()) {
5030 S += ",R";
Nico Weber4e8626f2013-05-08 23:47:40 +00005031 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_copy)
5032 S += ",C";
5033 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_retain)
5034 S += ",&";
Fariborz Jahanian33079ee2014-04-02 22:49:42 +00005035 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_weak)
5036 S += ",W";
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005037 } else {
5038 switch (PD->getSetterKind()) {
5039 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break;
5040 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy: S += ",C"; break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005041 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break;
Fariborz Jahanian70a315c2011-08-12 20:47:08 +00005042 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak: S += ",W"; break;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005043 }
5044 }
5045
5046 // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties
5047 // are "dynamic by default".
5048 if (Dynamic)
5049 S += ",D";
5050
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005051 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_nonatomic)
5052 S += ",N";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005053
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005054 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_getter) {
5055 S += ",G";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005056 S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005057 }
5058
5059 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_setter) {
5060 S += ",S";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005061 S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005062 }
5063
5064 if (SynthesizePID) {
5065 const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl();
5066 S += ",V";
Chris Lattner1cbaacc2008-11-24 04:00:27 +00005067 S += OID->getNameAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005068 }
5069
5070 // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong
5071}
5072
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005073/// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding -
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005074/// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as
5075/// 'l' or 'L' , but not always. For typedefs, we need to use
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005076/// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer!
5077///
5078void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const {
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005079 if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005080 if (const BuiltinType *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005081 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005082 PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005083 else
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005084 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005085 PointeeTy = IntTy;
5086 }
5087 }
5088}
5089
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005090void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005091 const FieldDecl *Field) const {
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005092 // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are
5093 // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that
5094 // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the
5095 // same type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005096 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, Field,
Fariborz Jahaniandaef00b2008-12-22 23:22:27 +00005097 true /* outermost type */);
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005098}
5099
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005100static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext *C,
5101 BuiltinType::Kind kind) {
5102 switch (kind) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005103 case BuiltinType::Void: return 'v';
5104 case BuiltinType::Bool: return 'B';
5105 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
5106 case BuiltinType::UChar: return 'C';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005107 case BuiltinType::Char16:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005108 case BuiltinType::UShort: return 'S';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005109 case BuiltinType::Char32:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005110 case BuiltinType::UInt: return 'I';
5111 case BuiltinType::ULong:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005112 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005113 case BuiltinType::UInt128: return 'T';
5114 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: return 'Q';
5115 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
5116 case BuiltinType::SChar: return 'c';
5117 case BuiltinType::Short: return 's';
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00005118 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
5119 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005120 case BuiltinType::Int: return 'i';
5121 case BuiltinType::Long:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005122 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005123 case BuiltinType::LongLong: return 'q';
5124 case BuiltinType::Int128: return 't';
5125 case BuiltinType::Float: return 'f';
5126 case BuiltinType::Double: return 'd';
Daniel Dunbar7cba5a72010-10-11 21:13:48 +00005127 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005128 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: return '*'; // like char*
5129
5130 case BuiltinType::Half:
5131 // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these!
5132 return ' ';
5133
5134 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
5135 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
5136 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
5137 llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type");
5138
5139 // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings.
5140 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
5141 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
5142 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
5143 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
5144 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
5145 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00005146 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00005147 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005148 case BuiltinType::Dependent:
5149#define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID)
5150#define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \
5151 case BuiltinType::KIND:
5152#include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
5153 llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005154 }
David Blaikie5a6a0202013-01-09 17:48:41 +00005155 llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005156}
5157
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005158static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) {
5159 EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl();
5160
5161 // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size.
5162 if (!Enum->isFixed())
5163 return 'i';
5164
5165 // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005166 const BuiltinType *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5167 return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(C, BT->getKind());
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005168}
5169
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005170static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S,
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005171 QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) {
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005172 assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl");
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005173 S += 'b';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005174 // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits.
5175 // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b,
5176 // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the
5177 // bitfield, then the size in bits. For example, in this structure:
5178 //
5179 // struct
5180 // {
5181 // int integer;
5182 // int flags:2;
5183 // };
5184 // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT
5185 // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime. The reason for this extra
5186 // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for
5187 // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that
5188 // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes...
John McCall5fb5df92012-06-20 06:18:46 +00005189 if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005190 const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent();
5191 const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Eli Friedmana3c122d2011-07-07 01:54:01 +00005192 S += llvm::utostr(RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex()));
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005193 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
5194 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005195 else {
5196 const BuiltinType *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5197 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(Ctx, BT->getKind());
5198 }
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005199 }
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005200 S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx));
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005201}
5202
Daniel Dunbar07d07852009-10-18 21:17:35 +00005203// FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string.
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005204void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string& S,
5205 bool ExpandPointedToStructures,
5206 bool ExpandStructures,
Daniel Dunbarc040ce42009-04-20 06:37:24 +00005207 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005208 bool OutermostType,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005209 bool EncodingProperty,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005210 bool StructField,
5211 bool EncodeBlockParameters,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005212 bool EncodeClassNames,
5213 bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) const {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005214 CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T);
5215 switch (CT->getTypeClass()) {
5216 case Type::Builtin:
5217 case Type::Enum:
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005218 if (FD && FD->isBitField())
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005219 return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005220 if (const BuiltinType *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT))
5221 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(this, BT->getKind());
5222 else
5223 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT));
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005224 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005225
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005226 case Type::Complex: {
5227 const ComplexType *CT = T->castAs<ComplexType>();
Anders Carlsson39b2e132009-04-09 21:55:45 +00005228 S += 'j';
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005229 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(CT->getElementType(), S, false, false, nullptr,
5230 false, false);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005231 return;
5232 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005233
5234 case Type::Atomic: {
5235 const AtomicType *AT = T->castAs<AtomicType>();
5236 S += 'A';
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005237 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getValueType(), S, false, false, nullptr,
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005238 false, false);
5239 return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ffd7062010-04-13 23:45:47 +00005240 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005241
5242 // encoding for pointer or reference types.
5243 case Type::Pointer:
5244 case Type::LValueReference:
5245 case Type::RValueReference: {
5246 QualType PointeeTy;
5247 if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) {
5248 const PointerType *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>();
5249 if (PT->isObjCSelType()) {
5250 S += ':';
5251 return;
5252 }
5253 PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
5254 } else {
5255 PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
5256 }
5257
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005258 bool isReadOnly = false;
5259 // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the
5260 // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'. The read-only qualifier of
5261 // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005262 // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type!
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005263 if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005264 if (OutermostType && T.isConstQualified()) {
5265 isReadOnly = true;
5266 S += 'r';
5267 }
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00005268 } else if (OutermostType) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005269 QualType P = PointeeTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005270 while (P->getAs<PointerType>())
5271 P = P->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005272 if (P.isConstQualified()) {
5273 isReadOnly = true;
5274 S += 'r';
5275 }
5276 }
5277 if (isReadOnly) {
5278 // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type
5279 // combinations need to be rearranged.
5280 // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn"
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00005281 if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr"))
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00005282 S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn");
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005283 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005284
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005285 if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) {
5286 // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a
5287 // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'.
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005288 if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) {
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005289 S += '*';
5290 return;
5291 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005292 } else if (const RecordType *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Steve Naroff3de6b702009-07-22 17:14:51 +00005293 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#".
5294 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) {
5295 S += '#';
5296 return;
5297 }
5298 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@".
5299 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) {
5300 S += '@';
5301 return;
5302 }
5303 // fall through...
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005304 }
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005305 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005306 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy);
5307
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005308 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005309 nullptr);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005310 return;
5311 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005312
5313 case Type::ConstantArray:
5314 case Type::IncompleteArray:
5315 case Type::VariableArray: {
5316 const ArrayType *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT);
5317
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005318 if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !StructField) {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005319 // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element.
5320 S += '^';
5321
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005322 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005323 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5324 } else {
5325 S += '[';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005326
Fariborz Jahanianf0dc11a2013-06-04 16:04:37 +00005327 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5328 S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue());
5329 else {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005330 //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005331 assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) &&
5332 "Unknown array type!");
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005333 S += '0';
5334 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005335
5336 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005337 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5338 S += ']';
5339 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005340 return;
5341 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005342
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005343 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
5344 case Type::FunctionProto:
Anders Carlssondf4cc612007-10-30 00:06:20 +00005345 S += '?';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005346 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005347
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005348 case Type::Record: {
5349 RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl();
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005350 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{';
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005351 // Anonymous structures print as '?'
5352 if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) {
5353 S += II->getName();
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005354 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
5355 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) {
5356 const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Benjamin Kramer9170e912013-02-22 15:46:01 +00005357 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S);
5358 TemplateSpecializationType::PrintTemplateArgumentList(OS,
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00005359 TemplateArgs.data(),
5360 TemplateArgs.size(),
Douglas Gregorc0b07282011-09-27 22:38:19 +00005361 (*this).getPrintingPolicy());
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005362 }
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005363 } else {
5364 S += '?';
5365 }
Daniel Dunbarfc1066d2008-10-17 20:21:44 +00005366 if (ExpandStructures) {
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005367 S += '=';
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005368 if (!RDecl->isUnion()) {
5369 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD);
5370 } else {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00005371 for (const auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005372 if (FD) {
5373 S += '"';
5374 S += Field->getNameAsString();
5375 S += '"';
5376 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005377
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005378 // Special case bit-fields.
5379 if (Field->isBitField()) {
5380 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true,
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00005381 Field);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005382 } else {
5383 QualType qt = Field->getType();
5384 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5385 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true,
5386 FD, /*OutermostType*/false,
5387 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
5388 /*StructField*/true);
5389 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005390 }
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005391 }
Fariborz Jahanianbc92fd72007-11-13 23:21:38 +00005392 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005393 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005394 return;
5395 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005396
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005397 case Type::BlockPointer: {
5398 const BlockPointerType *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>();
Steve Naroff49140cb2009-02-02 18:24:29 +00005399 S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?".
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005400 if (EncodeBlockParameters) {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005401 const FunctionType *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005402
5403 S += '<';
5404 // Block return type
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005405 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5406 FT->getReturnType(), S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures,
5407 FD, false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
5408 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005409 // Block self
5410 S += "@?";
5411 // Block parameters
5412 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
Aaron Ballman40bd0aa2014-03-17 15:23:01 +00005413 for (const auto &I : FPT->param_types())
5414 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5415 I, S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures, FD,
5416 false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
5417 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005418 }
5419 S += '>';
5420 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005421 return;
5422 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005423
Fariborz Jahanian33fa9622014-01-28 20:41:15 +00005424 case Type::ObjCObject: {
5425 // hack to match legacy encoding of *id and *Class
5426 QualType Ty = getObjCObjectPointerType(CT);
5427 if (Ty->isObjCIdType()) {
5428 S += "{objc_object=}";
5429 return;
5430 }
5431 else if (Ty->isObjCClassType()) {
5432 S += "{objc_class=}";
5433 return;
5434 }
5435 }
5436
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005437 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
5438 // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level.
5439 T = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getBaseType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005440
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005441 // The assumption seems to be that this assert will succeed
5442 // because nested levels will have filtered out 'id' and 'Class'.
5443 const ObjCInterfaceType *OIT = T->castAs<ObjCInterfaceType>();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005444 // @encode(class_name)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005445 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OIT->getDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005446 S += '{';
5447 const IdentifierInfo *II = OI->getIdentifier();
5448 S += II->getName();
5449 S += '=';
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005450 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005451 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5452 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005453 const FieldDecl *Field = cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]);
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005454 if (Field->isBitField())
5455 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, Field);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005456 else
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005457 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, FD,
5458 false, false, false, false, false,
5459 EncodePointerToObjCTypedef);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005460 }
5461 S += '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005462 return;
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005463 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005464
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005465 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
5466 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005467 if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) {
5468 S += '@';
5469 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005470 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005471
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00005472 if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) {
5473 // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'.
5474 // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with runtime
5475 // folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obsure construct.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005476 S += '#';
5477 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005478 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005479
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005480 if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005481 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(getObjCIdType(), S,
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005482 ExpandPointedToStructures,
5483 ExpandStructures, FD);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005484 if (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005485 // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list
5486 // Only when doing ivar or property encoding.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005487 S += '"';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005488 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005489 S += '<';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005490 S += I->getNameAsString();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005491 S += '>';
5492 }
5493 S += '"';
5494 }
5495 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005496 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005497
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005498 QualType PointeeTy = OPT->getPointeeType();
5499 if (!EncodingProperty &&
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005500 isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr()) &&
5501 !EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005502 // Another historical/compatibility reason.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005503 // We encode the underlying type which comes out as
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005504 // {...};
5505 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005506 if (FD && OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc682ef52013-07-12 16:41:56 +00005507 // Prevent recursive encoding of fields in some rare cases.
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005508 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OPT->getInterfaceDecl();
5509 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
5510 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5511 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
5512 if (cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]) == FD) {
5513 S += '{';
5514 S += OI->getIdentifier()->getName();
5515 S += '}';
5516 return;
5517 }
5518 }
5519 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005520 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S,
5521 false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005522 nullptr,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005523 false, false, false, false, false,
5524 /*EncodePointerToObjCTypedef*/true);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005525 return;
5526 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005527
5528 S += '@';
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005529 if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() &&
5530 (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames)) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005531 S += '"';
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00005532 S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getIdentifier()->getName();
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005533 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005534 S += '<';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005535 S += I->getNameAsString();
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005536 S += '>';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005537 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005538 S += '"';
5539 }
5540 return;
5541 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005542
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00005543 // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005544 // FIXME: we shoul do better than that. 'M' is available.
5545 case Type::MemberPointer:
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00005546 return;
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005547
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005548 case Type::Vector:
5549 case Type::ExtVector:
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005550 // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is
5551 // insufficient.
5552 // FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc.
5553 return;
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005554
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00005555 case Type::Auto:
5556 // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery.
5557 // Just ignore it.
5558 return;
5559
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005560#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5561#define TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5562#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5563 case Type::KIND:
5564#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5565 case Type::KIND:
5566#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5567 case Type::KIND:
5568#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
5569 llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!");
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005570 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005571 llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!");
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005572}
5573
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005574void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl,
5575 std::string &S,
5576 const FieldDecl *FD,
5577 bool includeVBases) const {
5578 assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl");
5579 assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions");
5580 if (!RDecl->getDefinition())
5581 return;
5582
5583 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl);
5584 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets;
5585 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl);
5586
5587 if (CXXRec) {
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +00005588 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->bases()) {
5589 if (!BI.isVirtual()) {
5590 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005591 if (base->isEmpty())
5592 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005593 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005594 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5595 std::make_pair(offs, base));
5596 }
5597 }
5598 }
5599
5600 unsigned i = 0;
5601 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator Field = RDecl->field_begin(),
5602 FieldEnd = RDecl->field_end();
5603 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field, ++i) {
5604 uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i);
5605 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
David Blaikie40ed2972012-06-06 20:45:41 +00005606 std::make_pair(offs, *Field));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005607 }
5608
5609 if (CXXRec && includeVBases) {
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +00005610 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->vbases()) {
5611 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005612 if (base->isEmpty())
5613 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005614 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base));
Eli Friedman1d24af82013-09-18 01:59:16 +00005615 if (offs >= uint64_t(toBits(layout.getNonVirtualSize())) &&
5616 FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis81c0b5c2011-09-26 18:14:24 +00005617 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(),
5618 std::make_pair(offs, base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005619 }
5620 }
5621
5622 CharUnits size;
5623 if (CXXRec) {
5624 size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize();
5625 } else {
5626 size = layout.getSize();
5627 }
5628
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005629#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005630 uint64_t CurOffs = 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005631#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005632 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator
5633 CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin();
5634
Douglas Gregorf5d6c742012-04-27 22:30:01 +00005635 if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() &&
5636 (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005637 if (FD) {
5638 S += "\"_vptr$";
5639 std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString();
5640 if (recname.empty()) recname = "?";
5641 S += recname;
5642 S += '"';
5643 }
5644 S += "^^?";
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005645#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005646 CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005647#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005648 }
5649
5650 if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
5651 // Mark the end of the structure.
5652 uint64_t offs = toBits(size);
5653 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005654 std::make_pair(offs, nullptr));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005655 }
5656
5657 for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) {
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005658#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005659 assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005660 if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) {
5661 uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs;
5662 // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that
5663 // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case
5664 // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout.
5665 // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without
5666 // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the
5667 // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be
5668 // longer then though.
5669 CurOffs += padding;
5670 }
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005671#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005672
5673 NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005674 if (!dcl)
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005675 break; // reached end of structure.
5676
5677 if (CXXRecordDecl *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) {
5678 // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going
5679 // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which
5680 // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy,
5681 // making the encoding type bigger than it really is.
5682 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005683 assert(!base->isEmpty());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005684#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005685 CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005686#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005687 } else {
5688 FieldDecl *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl);
5689 if (FD) {
5690 S += '"';
5691 S += field->getNameAsString();
5692 S += '"';
5693 }
5694
5695 if (field->isBitField()) {
5696 EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005697#ifndef NDEBUG
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005698 CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005699#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005700 } else {
5701 QualType qt = field->getType();
5702 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5703 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, FD,
5704 /*OutermostType*/false,
5705 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
5706 /*StructField*/true);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005707#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005708 CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005709#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005710 }
5711 }
5712 }
5713}
5714
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005715void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
Fariborz Jahanianac73ff82007-11-01 17:18:37 +00005716 std::string& S) const {
5717 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In)
5718 S += 'n';
5719 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout)
5720 S += 'N';
5721 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out)
5722 S += 'o';
5723 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy)
5724 S += 'O';
5725 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref)
5726 S += 'R';
5727 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway)
5728 S += 'V';
5729}
5730
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005731TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const {
5732 if (!ObjCIdDecl) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005733 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, nullptr, 0);
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005734 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005735 ObjCIdDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "id");
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005736 }
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005737 return ObjCIdDecl;
Steve Naroff66e9f332007-10-15 14:41:52 +00005738}
5739
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00005740TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const {
5741 if (!ObjCSelDecl) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005742 QualType T = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy);
5743 ObjCSelDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "SEL");
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00005744 }
5745 return ObjCSelDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian4bef4622007-10-16 20:40:23 +00005746}
5747
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005748TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const {
5749 if (!ObjCClassDecl) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005750 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, nullptr, 0);
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005751 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005752 ObjCClassDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "Class");
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005753 }
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005754 return ObjCClassDecl;
Anders Carlssonf56a7ae2007-10-31 02:53:19 +00005755}
5756
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00005757ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const {
5758 if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) {
5759 ObjCProtocolClassDecl
5760 = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5761 SourceLocation(),
5762 &Idents.get("Protocol"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005763 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr,
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00005764 SourceLocation(), true);
5765 }
5766
5767 return ObjCProtocolClassDecl;
5768}
5769
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005770//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5771// __builtin_va_list Construction Functions
5772//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5773
5774static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5775 // typedef char* __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005776 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy);
5777 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005778}
5779
5780static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5781 // typedef void* __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005782 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5783 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005784}
5785
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005786static TypedefDecl *
5787CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005788 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005789 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005790 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5791 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
5792 NamespaceDecl *NS;
5793 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5794 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005795 /*Inline*/ false, SourceLocation(),
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005796 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005797 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005798 NS->setImplicit();
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005799 VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005800 }
5801
5802 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5803
5804 const size_t NumFields = 5;
5805 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5806 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5807
5808 // void *__stack;
5809 FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5810 FieldNames[0] = "__stack";
5811
5812 // void *__gr_top;
5813 FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5814 FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top";
5815
5816 // void *__vr_top;
5817 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5818 FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top";
5819
5820 // int __gr_offs;
5821 FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy;
5822 FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs";
5823
5824 // int __vr_offs;
5825 FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy;
5826 FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs";
5827
5828 // Create fields
5829 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5830 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5831 VaListTagDecl,
5832 SourceLocation(),
5833 SourceLocation(),
5834 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005835 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5836 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005837 /*Mutable=*/false,
5838 ICIS_NoInit);
5839 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5840 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5841 }
5842 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5843 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
5844 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
5845
5846 // } __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005847 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__builtin_va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005848}
5849
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005850static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5851 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
5852 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
5853
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005854 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005855 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5856
5857 const size_t NumFields = 5;
5858 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5859 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5860
5861 // unsigned char gpr;
5862 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
5863 FieldNames[0] = "gpr";
5864
5865 // unsigned char fpr;
5866 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
5867 FieldNames[1] = "fpr";
5868
5869 // unsigned short reserved;
5870 FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy;
5871 FieldNames[2] = "reserved";
5872
5873 // void* overflow_arg_area;
5874 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5875 FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area";
5876
5877 // void* reg_save_area;
5878 FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5879 FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area";
5880
5881 // Create fields
5882 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5883 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl,
5884 SourceLocation(),
5885 SourceLocation(),
5886 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005887 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5888 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005889 /*Mutable=*/false,
5890 ICIS_NoInit);
5891 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5892 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5893 }
5894 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5895 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00005896 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005897
5898 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005899 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
5900 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
5901
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005902 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
5903 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
5904
5905 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
5906 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
5907 QualType VaListTagArrayType
5908 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
5909 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005910 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005911}
5912
5913static TypedefDecl *
5914CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5915 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
5916 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005917 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005918 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5919
5920 const size_t NumFields = 4;
5921 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5922 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5923
5924 // unsigned gp_offset;
5925 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
5926 FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset";
5927
5928 // unsigned fp_offset;
5929 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
5930 FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset";
5931
5932 // void* overflow_arg_area;
5933 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5934 FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area";
5935
5936 // void* reg_save_area;
5937 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5938 FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area";
5939
5940 // Create fields
5941 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5942 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5943 VaListTagDecl,
5944 SourceLocation(),
5945 SourceLocation(),
5946 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005947 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5948 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005949 /*Mutable=*/false,
5950 ICIS_NoInit);
5951 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5952 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5953 }
5954 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5955 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00005956 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005957
5958 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005959 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
5960 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
5961
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005962 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
5963 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
5964
5965 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
5966 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
5967 QualType VaListTagArrayType
5968 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
5969 Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005970 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005971}
5972
5973static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5974 // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4];
5975 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4);
5976 QualType IntArrayType
5977 = Context->getConstantArrayType(Context->IntTy,
5978 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005979 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(IntArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005980}
5981
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00005982static TypedefDecl *
5983CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005984 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005985 RecordDecl *VaListDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00005986 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5987 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
5988 NamespaceDecl *NS;
5989 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5990 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5991 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
5992 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005993 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005994 NS->setImplicit();
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00005995 VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00005996 }
5997
5998 VaListDecl->startDefinition();
5999
6000 // void * __ap;
6001 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6002 VaListDecl,
6003 SourceLocation(),
6004 SourceLocation(),
6005 &Context->Idents.get("__ap"),
6006 Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006007 /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6008 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006009 /*Mutable=*/false,
6010 ICIS_NoInit);
6011 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6012 VaListDecl->addDecl(Field);
6013
6014 // };
6015 VaListDecl->completeDefinition();
6016
6017 // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006018 QualType T = Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl);
6019 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006020}
6021
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006022static TypedefDecl *
6023CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6024 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6025 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006026 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006027 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6028
6029 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6030 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6031 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6032
6033 // long __gpr;
6034 FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy;
6035 FieldNames[0] = "__gpr";
6036
6037 // long __fpr;
6038 FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy;
6039 FieldNames[1] = "__fpr";
6040
6041 // void *__overflow_arg_area;
6042 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6043 FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area";
6044
6045 // void *__reg_save_area;
6046 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6047 FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area";
6048
6049 // Create fields
6050 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6051 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6052 VaListTagDecl,
6053 SourceLocation(),
6054 SourceLocation(),
6055 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006056 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6057 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006058 /*Mutable=*/false,
6059 ICIS_NoInit);
6060 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6061 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6062 }
6063 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6064 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6065 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
6066
6067 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006068 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
6069 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006070 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6071 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6072
6073 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6074 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6075 QualType VaListTagArrayType
6076 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6077 Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006078
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006079 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006080}
6081
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006082static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6083 TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) {
6084 switch (Kind) {
6085 case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList:
6086 return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6087 case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList:
6088 return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006089 case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6090 return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006091 case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList:
6092 return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6093 case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6094 return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6095 case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList:
6096 return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006097 case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList:
6098 return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006099 case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList:
6100 return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006101 }
6102
6103 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind");
6104}
6105
6106TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006107 if (!BuiltinVaListDecl) {
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006108 BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind());
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006109 assert(BuiltinVaListDecl->isImplicit());
6110 }
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006111
6112 return BuiltinVaListDecl;
6113}
6114
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006115QualType ASTContext::getVaListTagType() const {
6116 // Force the creation of VaListTagTy by building the __builtin_va_list
6117 // declaration.
6118 if (VaListTagTy.isNull())
6119 (void) getBuiltinVaListDecl();
6120
6121 return VaListTagTy;
6122}
6123
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006124void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006125 assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() &&
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006126 "'NSConstantString' type already set!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006127
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006128 ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006129}
6130
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006131/// \brief Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty
6132/// lookup.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006133TemplateName
6134ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
6135 UnresolvedSetIterator End) const {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006136 unsigned size = End - Begin;
6137 assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!");
6138
6139 void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) +
6140 size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*));
6141 OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = new(memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size);
6142
6143 NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00006144 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006145 NamedDecl *D = *I;
6146 assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) ||
6147 (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) &&
6148 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl())));
6149 *Storage++ = D;
6150 }
6151
6152 return TemplateName(OT);
6153}
6154
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006155/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified
6156/// template name such as \c std::vector.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006157TemplateName
6158ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6159 bool TemplateKeyword,
6160 TemplateDecl *Template) const {
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00006161 assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name");
6162
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006163 // FIXME: Canonicalization?
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006164 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6165 QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
6166
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006167 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006168 QualifiedTemplateName *QTN =
6169 QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6170 if (!QTN) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006171 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<QualifiedTemplateName>())
6172 QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006173 QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6174 }
6175
6176 return TemplateName(QTN);
6177}
6178
6179/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6180/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006181TemplateName
6182ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6183 const IdentifierInfo *Name) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006184 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor308047d2009-09-09 00:23:06 +00006185 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006186
6187 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6188 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name);
6189
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006190 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006191 DependentTemplateName *QTN =
6192 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6193
6194 if (QTN)
6195 return TemplateName(QTN);
6196
6197 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6198 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006199 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6200 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006201 } else {
6202 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006203 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6204 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006205 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN =
6206 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6207 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken");
6208 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006209 }
6210
6211 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6212 return TemplateName(QTN);
6213}
6214
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006215/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6216/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+.
6217TemplateName
6218ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006219 OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const {
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006220 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
6221 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
6222
6223 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6224 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006225
6226 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006227 DependentTemplateName *QTN
6228 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006229
6230 if (QTN)
6231 return TemplateName(QTN);
6232
6233 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6234 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006235 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6236 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006237 } else {
6238 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006239 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6240 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006241
6242 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN
6243 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6244 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken");
6245 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006246 }
6247
6248 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6249 return TemplateName(QTN);
6250}
6251
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006252TemplateName
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006253ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param,
6254 TemplateName replacement) const {
6255 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6256 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006257
6258 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006259 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
6260 = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
6261
6262 if (!subst) {
6263 subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement);
6264 SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos);
6265 }
6266
6267 return TemplateName(subst);
6268}
6269
6270TemplateName
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006271ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param,
6272 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const {
6273 ASTContext &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this);
6274 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6275 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006276
6277 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006278 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst
6279 = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6280
6281 if (!Subst) {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006282 Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param,
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006283 ArgPack.pack_size(),
6284 ArgPack.pack_begin());
6285 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos);
6286 }
6287
6288 return TemplateName(Subst);
6289}
6290
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006291/// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by
Douglas Gregorab138572008-11-03 15:57:00 +00006292/// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type
6293/// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType.
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006294CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const {
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006295 switch (Type) {
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006296 case TargetInfo::NoInt: return CanQualType();
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00006297 case TargetInfo::SignedChar: return SignedCharTy;
6298 case TargetInfo::UnsignedChar: return UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006299 case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy;
6300 case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy;
6301 case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy;
6302 case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy;
6303 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy;
6304 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy;
6305 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy;
6306 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy;
6307 }
6308
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00006309 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value");
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006310}
Ted Kremenek77c51b22008-07-24 23:58:27 +00006311
6312//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6313// Type Predicates.
6314//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6315
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006316/// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's
6317/// garbage collection attribute.
6318///
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006319Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006320 if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC)
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006321 return Qualifiers::GCNone;
6322
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006323 assert(getLangOpts().ObjC1);
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006324 Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr();
6325
6326 // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers
6327 // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared
6328 // as __strong.
6329 if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) {
6330 if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
6331 return Qualifiers::Strong;
6332 else if (Ty->isPointerType())
6333 return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
6334 } else {
6335 // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a
6336 // pointer.
6337#ifndef NDEBUG
6338 QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
6339 while (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT))
6340 CT = AT->getElementType();
6341 assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType());
6342#endif
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006343 }
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00006344 return GCAttrs;
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006345}
6346
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006347//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6348// Type Compatibility Testing
6349//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattnerb338a6b2007-11-01 05:03:41 +00006350
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006351/// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006352/// compatible.
6353static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS,
6354 const VectorType *RHS) {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00006355 assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006356 return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006357 LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006358}
6359
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006360bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,
6361 QualType SecondVec) {
6362 assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type");
6363 assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type");
6364
6365 if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec))
6366 return true;
6367
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006368 // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the
6369 // equivalent GCC vector types.
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006370 const VectorType *First = FirstVec->getAs<VectorType>();
6371 const VectorType *Second = SecondVec->getAs<VectorType>();
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006372 if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() &&
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006373 hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) &&
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006374 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6375 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
6376 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6377 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool)
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006378 return true;
6379
6380 return false;
6381}
6382
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006383//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6384// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's.
6385//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6386
6387/// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the
6388/// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006389bool
6390ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto,
6391 ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00006392 if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006393 return true;
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00006394 for (auto *PI : rProto->protocols())
6395 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, PI))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006396 return true;
6397 return false;
6398}
6399
Dmitri Gribenko4364fcf2012-08-28 02:49:14 +00006400/// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare Class<pr,...> and
6401/// Class<pr1, ...>.
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006402bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs,
6403 QualType rhs) {
6404 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6405 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6406 assert ((lhsQID && rhsOPT) && "ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible");
6407
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006408 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006409 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006410 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006411 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) {
6412 match = true;
6413 break;
6414 }
6415 }
6416 if (!match)
6417 return false;
6418 }
6419 return true;
6420}
6421
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006422/// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an
6423/// ObjCQualifiedIDType.
6424bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6425 bool compare) {
6426 // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' or void* type in all cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006427 if (lhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006428 lhs->isObjCIdType() || lhs->isObjCClassType())
6429 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006430 else if (rhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006431 rhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCClassType())
6432 return true;
6433
6434 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006435 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006436
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006437 if (!rhsOPT) return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006438
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006439 if (rhsOPT->qual_empty()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006440 // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006441 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6442 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006443 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006444 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6445 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6446 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006447 if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006448 return false;
6449 }
6450 }
6451 // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'.
6452 return true;
6453 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006454 // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006455 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006456 bool match = false;
6457
6458 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6459 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6460 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006461 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006462 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6463 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6464 match = true;
6465 break;
6466 }
6467 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006468 // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006469 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6470 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006471 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006472 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6473 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6474 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006475 if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true)) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006476 match = true;
6477 break;
6478 }
6479 }
6480 }
6481 if (!match)
6482 return false;
6483 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006484
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006485 return true;
6486 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006487
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006488 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsQID = rhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType();
6489 assert(rhsQID && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>");
6490
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006491 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT =
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006492 lhs->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006493 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006494 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006495 bool match = false;
6496
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006497 // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006498 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6499 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006500 // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct
6501 // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006502 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006503 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6504 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6505 match = true;
6506 break;
6507 }
6508 }
6509 if (!match)
6510 return false;
6511 }
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006512
6513 // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols
6514 // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
6515 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6516 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
6517 CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols);
6518 // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has
6519 // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s)
6520 // assume that it is mismatch.
6521 if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhsOPT->qual_empty())
6522 return false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006523 for (auto *lhsProto : LHSInheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006524 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006525 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006526 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6527 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6528 match = true;
6529 break;
6530 }
6531 }
6532 if (!match)
6533 return false;
6534 }
6535 }
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006536 return true;
6537 }
6538 return false;
6539}
6540
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006541/// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006542/// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS. This handles validation of any
6543/// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS.
6544///
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006545bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6546 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006547 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6548 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6549
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00006550 // If either type represents the built-in 'id' or 'Class' types, return true.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006551 if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() ||
6552 RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006553 return true;
6554
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006555 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006556 return ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6557 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006558 false);
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006559
6560 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass())
6561 return ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6562 QualType(RHSOPT,0));
6563
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006564 // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path.
6565 if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface())
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006566 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006567
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006568 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006569}
6570
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006571/// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written
Chris Lattner57540c52011-04-15 05:22:18 +00006572/// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006573/// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where
6574/// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is
6575/// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK.
6576bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
6577 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006578 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
6579 bool BlockReturnType) {
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00006580 if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006581 return true;
6582
6583 if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
6584 return RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType();
6585 }
6586
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00006587 if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006588 return ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6589 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
6590 false);
6591
6592 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6593 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6594 if (LHS && RHS) { // We have 2 user-defined types.
6595 if (LHS != RHS) {
6596 if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl()))
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006597 return BlockReturnType;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006598 if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl()))
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006599 return !BlockReturnType;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006600 }
6601 else
6602 return true;
6603 }
6604 return false;
6605}
6606
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006607/// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set
6608/// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects.
6609/// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of
6610/// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects.
6611static
6612void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context,
6613 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6614 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006615 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionOfProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006616
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006617 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6618 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6619 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base");
6620 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base");
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006621
6622 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocolSet;
6623 unsigned LHSNumProtocols = LHS->getNumProtocols();
6624 if (LHSNumProtocols > 0)
6625 InheritedProtocolSet.insert(LHS->qual_begin(), LHS->qual_end());
6626 else {
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006627 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006628 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(),
6629 LHSInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006630 InheritedProtocolSet.insert(LHSInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6631 LHSInheritedProtocols.end());
6632 }
6633
6634 unsigned RHSNumProtocols = RHS->getNumProtocols();
6635 if (RHSNumProtocols > 0) {
Dan Gohman145f3f12010-04-19 16:39:44 +00006636 ObjCProtocolDecl **RHSProtocols =
6637 const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl **>(RHS->qual_begin());
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006638 for (unsigned i = 0; i < RHSNumProtocols; ++i)
6639 if (InheritedProtocolSet.count(RHSProtocols[i]))
6640 IntersectionOfProtocols.push_back(RHSProtocols[i]);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00006641 } else {
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006642 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSInheritedProtocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006643 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(),
6644 RHSInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006645 for (llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*,8>::iterator I =
6646 RHSInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6647 E = RHSInheritedProtocols.end(); I != E; ++I)
6648 if (InheritedProtocolSet.count((*I)))
6649 IntersectionOfProtocols.push_back((*I));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006650 }
6651}
6652
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006653/// areCommonBaseCompatible - Returns common base class of the two classes if
6654/// one found. Note that this is O'2 algorithm. But it will be called as the
6655/// last type comparison in a ?-exp of ObjC pointer types before a
6656/// warning is issued. So, its invokation is extremely rare.
6657QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible(
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006658 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr,
6659 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) {
6660 const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType();
6661 const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType();
6662 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface();
6663 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface();
Douglas Gregor0b144e12011-12-15 00:29:59 +00006664 if (!LDecl || !RDecl || (declaresSameEntity(LDecl, RDecl)))
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006665 return QualType();
6666
Fariborz Jahanianb1071432011-04-18 21:16:59 +00006667 do {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006668 LHS = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(getObjCInterfaceType(LDecl));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006669 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS)) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006670 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006671 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, Lptr, Rptr, Protocols);
6672
6673 QualType Result = QualType(LHS, 0);
6674 if (!Protocols.empty())
6675 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, Protocols.data(), Protocols.size());
6676 Result = getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
6677 return Result;
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006678 }
Fariborz Jahanianb1071432011-04-18 21:16:59 +00006679 } while ((LDecl = LDecl->getSuperClass()));
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006680
6681 return QualType();
6682}
6683
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006684bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS,
6685 const ObjCObjectType *RHS) {
6686 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type");
6687 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type");
6688
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006689 // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of
6690 // the LHS.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006691 if (!LHS->getInterface()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface()))
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006692 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006693
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006694 // RHS must have a superset of the protocols in the LHS. If the LHS is not
6695 // protocol qualified at all, then we are good.
Steve Naroffc277ad12009-07-18 15:33:26 +00006696 if (LHS->getNumProtocols() == 0)
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006697 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006698
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006699 // Okay, we know the LHS has protocol qualifiers. If the RHS doesn't,
6700 // more detailed analysis is required.
6701 if (RHS->getNumProtocols() == 0) {
6702 // OK, if LHS is a superclass of RHS *and*
6703 // this superclass is assignment compatible with LHS.
6704 // false otherwise.
Fariborz Jahanian240400b2011-04-12 16:34:14 +00006705 bool IsSuperClass =
6706 LHS->getInterface()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface());
6707 if (IsSuperClass) {
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006708 // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types
6709 // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols
6710 // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok.
6711 // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>.
6712 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols;
Fariborz Jahanian240400b2011-04-12 16:34:14 +00006713 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006714 // If super class has no protocols, it is not a match.
6715 if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty())
6716 return false;
6717
Aaron Ballman1683f7b2014-03-17 15:55:30 +00006718 for (const auto *LHSProto : LHS->quals()) {
6719 bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false;
6720 for (auto *SuperClassProto : SuperClassInheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006721 if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) {
6722 SuperImplementsProtocol = true;
6723 break;
6724 }
6725 }
6726 if (!SuperImplementsProtocol)
6727 return false;
6728 }
6729 return true;
6730 }
6731 return false;
6732 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006733
Aaron Ballman1683f7b2014-03-17 15:55:30 +00006734 for (const auto *LHSPI : LHS->quals()) {
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006735 bool RHSImplementsProtocol = false;
6736
6737 // If the RHS doesn't implement the protocol on the left, the types
6738 // are incompatible.
Aaron Ballman1683f7b2014-03-17 15:55:30 +00006739 for (auto *RHSPI : RHS->quals()) {
6740 if (RHSPI->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSPI->getIdentifier())) {
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006741 RHSImplementsProtocol = true;
Steve Narofffac5bc92009-07-16 16:21:02 +00006742 break;
6743 }
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006744 }
6745 // FIXME: For better diagnostics, consider passing back the protocol name.
6746 if (!RHSImplementsProtocol)
6747 return false;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006748 }
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006749 // The RHS implements all protocols listed on the LHS.
6750 return true;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006751}
6752
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006753bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
6754 // get the "pointed to" types
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006755 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6756 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006757
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006758 if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT)
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006759 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006760
6761 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) ||
6762 canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT);
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006763}
6764
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00006765bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) {
6766 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(
6767 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
6768 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>());
6769}
6770
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006771/// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible,
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00006772/// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006773/// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00006774/// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules.
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006775bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
6776 bool CompareUnqualified) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006777 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00006778 return hasSameType(LHS, RHS);
6779
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006780 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006781}
6782
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00006783bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
Fariborz Jahanianc87c8792011-07-12 23:20:13 +00006784 return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00006785}
6786
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006787bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
6788 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull();
6789}
6790
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006791/// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member
6792/// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return
6793/// QualType()
6794QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType,
6795 bool OfBlockPointer,
6796 bool Unqualified) {
6797 if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) {
6798 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
6799 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00006800 for (const auto *I : UD->fields()) {
6801 QualType ET = I->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006802 QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6803 if (!MT.isNull())
6804 return MT;
6805 }
6806 }
6807 }
6808
6809 return QualType();
6810}
6811
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00006812/// mergeFunctionParameterTypes - merge two types which appear as function
6813/// parameter types
6814QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6815 bool OfBlockPointer,
6816 bool Unqualified) {
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006817 // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function
6818 // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other
6819 // type is compatible with a union member
6820 QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer,
6821 Unqualified);
6822 if (!lmerge.isNull())
6823 return lmerge;
6824
6825 QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer,
6826 Unqualified);
6827 if (!rmerge.isNull())
6828 return rmerge;
6829
6830 return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6831}
6832
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006833QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006834 bool OfBlockPointer,
6835 bool Unqualified) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006836 const FunctionType *lbase = lhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
6837 const FunctionType *rbase = rhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00006838 const FunctionProtoType *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase);
6839 const FunctionProtoType *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006840 bool allLTypes = true;
6841 bool allRTypes = true;
6842
6843 // Check return type
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006844 QualType retType;
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00006845 if (OfBlockPointer) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006846 QualType RHS = rbase->getReturnType();
6847 QualType LHS = lbase->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00006848 bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified;
6849 if (!UnqualifiedResult)
6850 UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers());
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006851 retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true);
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00006852 }
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006853 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006854 retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getReturnType(), rbase->getReturnType(), false,
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006855 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006856 if (retType.isNull()) return QualType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006857
6858 if (Unqualified)
6859 retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType();
6860
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006861 CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getReturnType());
6862 CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getReturnType());
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006863 if (Unqualified) {
6864 LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
6865 RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
6866 }
6867
6868 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006869 allLTypes = false;
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006870 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006871 allRTypes = false;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006872
Daniel Dunbaredd5bae2010-04-28 16:20:58 +00006873 // FIXME: double check this
6874 // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
6875 // rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
6876 // lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()?
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00006877 FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo();
6878 FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006879
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00006880 // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00006881 if (lbaseInfo.getCC() != rbaseInfo.getCC())
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00006882 return QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006883
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006884 // Regparm is part of the calling convention.
Eli Friedmanc5b20b52011-04-09 08:18:08 +00006885 if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm())
6886 return QualType();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006887 if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm())
6888 return QualType();
6889
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006890 if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult())
6891 return QualType();
6892
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006893 // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'.
6894 bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006895
Rafael Espindola8778c282012-11-29 16:09:03 +00006896 if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
6897 allLTypes = false;
6898 if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
6899 allRTypes = false;
6900
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006901 FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn);
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00006902
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006903 if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00006904 assert(!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec() &&
6905 "C++ shouldn't be here");
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006906 // Compatible functions must have the same number of parameters
6907 if (lproto->getNumParams() != rproto->getNumParams())
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006908 return QualType();
6909
6910 // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible
6911 if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic())
6912 return QualType();
6913
Argyrios Kyrtzidis22a37352008-10-26 16:43:14 +00006914 if (lproto->getTypeQuals() != rproto->getTypeQuals())
6915 return QualType();
6916
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00006917 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
6918 !FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(rproto, lproto))
6919 return QualType();
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006920
6921 // Check parameter type compatibility
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006922 SmallVector<QualType, 10> types;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006923 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lproto->getNumParams(); i < n; i++) {
6924 QualType lParamType = lproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
6925 QualType rParamType = rproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
6926 QualType paramType = mergeFunctionParameterTypes(
6927 lParamType, rParamType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6928 if (paramType.isNull())
6929 return QualType();
6930
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006931 if (Unqualified)
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006932 paramType = paramType.getUnqualifiedType();
6933
6934 types.push_back(paramType);
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006935 if (Unqualified) {
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006936 lParamType = lParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
6937 rParamType = rParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006938 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006939
6940 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(lParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006941 allLTypes = false;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006942 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(rParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006943 allRTypes = false;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006944 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00006945
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006946 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
6947 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00006948
6949 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo();
6950 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00006951 return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006952 }
6953
6954 if (lproto) allRTypes = false;
6955 if (rproto) allLTypes = false;
6956
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00006957 const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006958 if (proto) {
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00006959 assert(!proto->hasExceptionSpec() && "C++ shouldn't be here");
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006960 if (proto->isVariadic()) return QualType();
6961 // Check that the types are compatible with the types that
6962 // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15).
6963 // The only types actually affected are promotable integer
6964 // types and floats, which would be passed as a different
6965 // type depending on whether the prototype is visible.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006966 for (unsigned i = 0, n = proto->getNumParams(); i < n; ++i) {
6967 QualType paramTy = proto->getParamType(i);
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00006968
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00006969 // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used
Douglas Gregor2973d402010-02-03 19:27:29 +00006970 // to pass enum values.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006971 if (const EnumType *Enum = paramTy->getAs<EnumType>()) {
6972 paramTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
6973 if (paramTy.isNull())
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00006974 return QualType();
6975 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006976
6977 if (paramTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ||
6978 getCanonicalType(paramTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy)
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006979 return QualType();
6980 }
6981
6982 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
6983 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00006984
6985 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo();
6986 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00006987 return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006988 }
6989
6990 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
6991 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006992 return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006993}
6994
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00006995/// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them.
6996static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET,
6997 QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) {
6998 // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char,
6999 // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type.
7000 // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion
7001 // type.
7002 QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7003 if (underlyingType.isNull()) return QualType();
7004 if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other))
7005 return other;
7006
7007 // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any
7008 // integral type of the same size.
7009 if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() &&
7010 Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other))
7011 return other;
7012
7013 return QualType();
7014}
7015
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007016QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007017 bool OfBlockPointer,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007018 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) {
Bill Wendlingdb4e3492007-12-03 07:33:35 +00007019 // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the
7020 // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression
7021 // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007022 // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and
7023 // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses).
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007024 assert(!LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "LHS is a reference type?");
7025 assert(!RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "RHS is a reference type?");
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007026
7027 if (Unqualified) {
7028 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7029 RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7030 }
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007031
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007032 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7033 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7034
7035 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7036 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7037 return LHS;
7038
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007039 // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00007040 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7041 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007042 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7043 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type
7044 // mismatch.
7045 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007046 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() ||
7047 LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime())
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007048 return QualType();
7049
7050 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7051 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7052 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7053 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7054 // qualified __strong.
7055 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7056 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7057 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7058
7059 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7060 return QualType();
7061
7062 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7063 return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong));
7064 }
7065 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7066 return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS);
7067 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007068 return QualType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007069 }
7070
7071 // Okay, qualifiers are equal.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007072
Eli Friedmandcca6332009-06-01 01:22:52 +00007073 Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass();
7074 Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007075
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007076 // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these
7077 // comparisons, just force one to the other.
7078 if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
7079 if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
Eli Friedman16f90962008-02-12 08:23:06 +00007080
7081 // Same as above for arrays
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007082 if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7083 LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
7084 if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7085 RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007086
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007087 // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects.
7088 if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7089 if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7090
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00007091 // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector.
7092 if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector;
7093 if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007094
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007095 // If the canonical type classes don't match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007096 if (LHSClass != RHSClass) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007097 // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum
7098 // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007099 if (const EnumType* ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007100 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007101 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007102 if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007103 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007104 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007105 // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type.
Fariborz Jahanian194904e2012-01-26 17:08:50 +00007106 if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) {
7107 if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType())
7108 return LHS;
7109 if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType())
7110 return RHS;
7111 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007112
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007113 return QualType();
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007114 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007115
Steve Naroffc6edcbd2008-01-09 22:43:08 +00007116 // The canonical type classes match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007117 switch (LHSClass) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007118#define TYPE(Class, Base)
7119#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
John McCallbd8d9bd2010-03-01 23:49:17 +00007120#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007121#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7122#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7123#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007124 llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007125
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00007126 case Type::Auto:
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007127 case Type::LValueReference:
7128 case Type::RValueReference:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007129 case Type::MemberPointer:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007130 llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007131
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007132 case Type::ObjCInterface:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007133 case Type::IncompleteArray:
7134 case Type::VariableArray:
7135 case Type::FunctionProto:
7136 case Type::ExtVector:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007137 llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007138
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007139 case Type::Pointer:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007140 {
7141 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007142 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7143 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007144 if (Unqualified) {
7145 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7146 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7147 }
7148 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false,
7149 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007150 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007151 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007152 return LHS;
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007153 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007154 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007155 return getPointerType(ResultType);
7156 }
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007157 case Type::BlockPointer:
7158 {
7159 // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007160 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7161 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007162 if (Unqualified) {
7163 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7164 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7165 }
7166 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer,
7167 Unqualified);
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007168 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7169 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7170 return LHS;
7171 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7172 return RHS;
7173 return getBlockPointerType(ResultType);
7174 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00007175 case Type::Atomic:
7176 {
7177 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7178 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7179 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7180 if (Unqualified) {
7181 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7182 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7183 }
7184 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
7185 Unqualified);
7186 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7187 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7188 return LHS;
7189 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7190 return RHS;
7191 return getAtomicType(ResultType);
7192 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007193 case Type::ConstantArray:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007194 {
7195 const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS);
7196 const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS);
7197 if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize())
7198 return QualType();
7199
7200 QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType();
7201 QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007202 if (Unqualified) {
7203 LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7204 RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7205 }
7206
7207 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007208 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007209 if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7210 return LHS;
7211 if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7212 return RHS;
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007213 if (LCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(),
7214 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
7215 if (RCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(),
7216 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007217 const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS);
7218 const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS);
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007219 if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7220 return LHS;
7221 if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7222 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007223 if (LVAT) {
7224 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7225 // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type
7226 // has to be different.
7227 return LHS;
7228 }
7229 if (RVAT) {
7230 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7231 // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type
7232 // has to be different.
7233 return RHS;
7234 }
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007235 if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS;
7236 if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS;
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00007237 return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType,
7238 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007239 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007240 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007241 return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007242 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007243 case Type::Enum:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007244 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007245 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007246 // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007247 return QualType();
Daniel Dunbar804c0442009-01-28 21:22:12 +00007248 case Type::Complex:
7249 // Distinct complex types are incompatible.
7250 return QualType();
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007251 case Type::Vector:
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007252 // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector!
John McCall44c064b2010-03-12 23:14:13 +00007253 if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->getAs<VectorType>(),
7254 RHSCan->getAs<VectorType>()))
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007255 return LHS;
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007256 return QualType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007257 case Type::ObjCObject: {
7258 // Check if the types are assignment compatible.
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007259 // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether
7260 // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007261 const ObjCObjectType* LHSIface = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7262 const ObjCObjectType* RHSIface = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7263 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSIface, RHSIface))
Steve Naroff7a7814c2009-02-21 16:18:07 +00007264 return LHS;
7265
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007266 return QualType();
Cedric Venet4fc88b72009-02-21 17:14:49 +00007267 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007268 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007269 if (OfBlockPointer) {
7270 if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7271 LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007272 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7273 BlockReturnType))
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007274 return LHS;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007275 return QualType();
7276 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007277 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7278 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007279 return LHS;
7280
Steve Naroffc68cfcf2008-12-10 22:14:21 +00007281 return QualType();
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007282 }
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007283 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007284
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007285 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!");
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007286}
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00007287
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007288bool ASTContext::FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(
7289 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType,
7290 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType) {
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007291 if (FromFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams() !=
7292 ToFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams())
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007293 return false;
7294 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo FromEPI =
7295 FromFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
7296 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ToEPI =
7297 ToFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00007298 if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters && ToEPI.ConsumedParameters)
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007299 for (unsigned i = 0, n = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); i != n; ++i) {
7300 if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters[i] != ToEPI.ConsumedParameters[i])
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007301 return false;
7302 }
7303 return true;
7304}
7305
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007306/// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and
7307/// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function
7308/// return types.
7309QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7310 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7311 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7312 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7313 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7314 return LHS;
7315 if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) {
7316 if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType())
7317 return QualType();
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007318 QualType OldReturnType =
7319 cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007320 QualType NewReturnType =
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007321 cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007322 QualType ResReturnType =
7323 mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType);
7324 if (ResReturnType.isNull())
7325 return QualType();
7326 if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) {
7327 // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo();
7328 // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type.
7329 const FunctionType *F = LHS->getAs<FunctionType>();
7330 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) {
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007331 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
7332 EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS);
Reid Kleckner896b32f2013-06-10 20:51:09 +00007333 QualType ResultType =
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007334 getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007335 return ResultType;
7336 }
7337 }
7338 return QualType();
7339 }
7340
7341 // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged.
7342 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7343 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7344 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7345 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch.
7346 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
7347 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace())
7348 return QualType();
7349
7350 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7351 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7352 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7353 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7354 // qualified __strong.
7355 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7356 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7357 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7358
7359 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7360 return QualType();
7361
7362 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong)
7363 return LHS;
7364 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong)
7365 return RHS;
7366 return QualType();
7367 }
7368
7369 if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7370 QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7371 QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7372 QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT);
7373 if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT)
7374 return LHS;
7375 if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT)
7376 return RHS;
7377 }
7378 return QualType();
7379}
7380
Chris Lattner4ba0cef2008-04-07 07:01:58 +00007381//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007382// Integer Predicates
7383//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner3c919712009-01-16 07:15:35 +00007384
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007385unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const {
Richard Smithe9521062013-10-15 04:56:17 +00007386 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedmanee275c82009-12-10 22:29:29 +00007387 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00007388 if (T->isBooleanType())
7389 return 1;
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00007390 // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007391 return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T);
7392}
7393
Abramo Bagnara13640492012-09-09 10:21:24 +00007394QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00007395 assert(T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() && "Unexpected type");
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007396
7397 // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int>
7398 if (const VectorType *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
7399 return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00007400 VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007401
7402 // For enums, we return the unsigned version of the base type.
7403 if (const EnumType *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007404 T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007405
7406 const BuiltinType *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
7407 assert(BTy && "Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007408 switch (BTy->getKind()) {
7409 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
7410 case BuiltinType::SChar:
7411 return UnsignedCharTy;
7412 case BuiltinType::Short:
7413 return UnsignedShortTy;
7414 case BuiltinType::Int:
7415 return UnsignedIntTy;
7416 case BuiltinType::Long:
7417 return UnsignedLongTy;
7418 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
7419 return UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00007420 case BuiltinType::Int128:
7421 return UnsignedInt128Ty;
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007422 default:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007423 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007424 }
7425}
7426
Argyrios Kyrtzidis65ad5692010-10-24 17:26:36 +00007427ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() { }
7428
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00007429void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD,
7430 QualType ReturnType) {}
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007431
7432//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7433// Builtin Type Computation
7434//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7435
7436/// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007437/// pointer over the consumed characters. This returns the resultant type. If
7438/// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic
7439/// types. This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of
7440/// a vector of "i*".
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007441///
7442/// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required
7443/// to be an Integer Constant Expression.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007444static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007445 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007446 bool &RequiresICE,
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007447 bool AllowTypeModifiers) {
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007448 // Modifiers.
7449 int HowLong = 0;
7450 bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007451 RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007452
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007453 // Read the prefixed modifiers first.
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007454 bool Done = false;
7455 while (!Done) {
7456 switch (*Str++) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007457 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007458 case 'I':
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007459 RequiresICE = true;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007460 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007461 case 'S':
7462 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7463 assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
7464 Signed = true;
7465 break;
7466 case 'U':
7467 assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7468 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
7469 Unsigned = true;
7470 break;
7471 case 'L':
7472 assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier");
7473 ++HowLong;
7474 break;
Kevin Qinad64f6d2014-02-24 02:45:03 +00007475 case 'W':
7476 // This modifier represents int64 type.
7477 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'W' modifiers!");
7478 switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getInt64Type()) {
7479 default:
7480 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type");
7481 case TargetInfo::SignedLong:
7482 HowLong = 1;
7483 break;
7484 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong:
7485 HowLong = 2;
7486 break;
7487 }
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007488 }
7489 }
7490
7491 QualType Type;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007492
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007493 // Read the base type.
7494 switch (*Str++) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007495 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007496 case 'v':
7497 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7498 "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!");
7499 Type = Context.VoidTy;
7500 break;
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00007501 case 'h':
7502 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7503 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
7504 Type = Context.HalfTy;
7505 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007506 case 'f':
7507 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7508 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
7509 Type = Context.FloatTy;
7510 break;
7511 case 'd':
7512 assert(HowLong < 2 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7513 "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!");
7514 if (HowLong)
7515 Type = Context.LongDoubleTy;
7516 else
7517 Type = Context.DoubleTy;
7518 break;
7519 case 's':
7520 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!");
7521 if (Unsigned)
7522 Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
7523 else
7524 Type = Context.ShortTy;
7525 break;
7526 case 'i':
7527 if (HowLong == 3)
7528 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty;
7529 else if (HowLong == 2)
7530 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
7531 else if (HowLong == 1)
7532 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
7533 else
7534 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
7535 break;
7536 case 'c':
7537 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!");
7538 if (Signed)
7539 Type = Context.SignedCharTy;
7540 else if (Unsigned)
7541 Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
7542 else
7543 Type = Context.CharTy;
7544 break;
7545 case 'b': // boolean
7546 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!");
7547 Type = Context.BoolTy;
7548 break;
7549 case 'z': // size_t.
7550 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!");
7551 Type = Context.getSizeType();
7552 break;
7553 case 'F':
7554 Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType();
7555 break;
Fariborz Jahaniand11da7e2010-11-09 21:38:20 +00007556 case 'G':
7557 Type = Context.getObjCIdType();
7558 break;
7559 case 'H':
7560 Type = Context.getObjCSelType();
7561 break;
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00007562 case 'M':
7563 Type = Context.getObjCSuperType();
7564 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007565 case 'a':
7566 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
7567 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
7568 break;
7569 case 'A':
7570 // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly
7571 // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two
7572 // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones
7573 // passed by reference. An example of a by-value va_list is
7574 // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list
7575 // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86,
7576 // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want
7577 // it to be a __va_list_tag*.
7578 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
7579 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007580 if (Type->isArrayType())
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007581 Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type);
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007582 else
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007583 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007584 break;
7585 case 'V': {
7586 char *End;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007587 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7588 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007589 Str = End;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007590
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007591 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
7592 RequiresICE, false);
7593 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007594
7595 // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet.
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00007596 Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00007597 VectorType::GenericVector);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007598 break;
7599 }
Douglas Gregorfed66992012-06-07 18:08:25 +00007600 case 'E': {
7601 char *End;
7602
7603 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7604 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
7605
7606 Str = End;
7607
7608 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
7609 false);
7610 Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
7611 break;
7612 }
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00007613 case 'X': {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007614 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
7615 false);
7616 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE");
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00007617 Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType);
7618 break;
Fariborz Jahanian73952fc2011-08-23 23:33:09 +00007619 }
7620 case 'Y' : {
7621 Type = Context.getPointerDiffType();
7622 break;
7623 }
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00007624 case 'P':
Douglas Gregor27821ce2009-07-07 16:35:42 +00007625 Type = Context.getFILEType();
7626 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007627 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007628 return QualType();
7629 }
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007630 break;
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00007631 case 'J':
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007632 if (Signed)
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00007633 Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType();
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007634 else
7635 Type = Context.getjmp_bufType();
7636
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007637 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007638 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp;
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007639 return QualType();
7640 }
7641 break;
Rafael Espindola6cfa82b2011-11-13 21:51:09 +00007642 case 'K':
7643 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!");
7644 Type = Context.getucontext_tType();
7645
7646 if (Type.isNull()) {
7647 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext;
7648 return QualType();
7649 }
7650 break;
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00007651 case 'p':
7652 Type = Context.getProcessIDType();
7653 break;
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00007654 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007655
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007656 // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it.
7657 Done = !AllowTypeModifiers;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007658 while (!Done) {
John McCallb8b94662010-03-12 04:21:28 +00007659 switch (char c = *Str++) {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007660 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
7661 case '*':
7662 case '&': {
7663 // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types
7664 // qualified with an address space.
7665 char *End;
7666 unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7667 if (End != Str && AddrSpace != 0) {
7668 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, AddrSpace);
7669 Str = End;
7670 }
7671 if (c == '*')
7672 Type = Context.getPointerType(Type);
7673 else
7674 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
7675 break;
7676 }
7677 // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg.
7678 case 'C':
7679 Type = Type.withConst();
7680 break;
7681 case 'D':
7682 Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type);
7683 break;
Ted Kremenekf2a2f5f2012-01-20 21:40:12 +00007684 case 'R':
7685 Type = Type.withRestrict();
7686 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007687 }
7688 }
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007689
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007690 assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) &&
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007691 "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007692
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007693 return Type;
7694}
7695
7696/// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin.
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007697QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007698 GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007699 unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007700 const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.GetTypeString(Id);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007701
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007702 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007703
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007704 bool RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007705 Error = GE_None;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007706 QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error,
7707 RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007708 if (Error != GE_None)
7709 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007710
7711 assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE");
7712
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007713 while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007714 QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007715 if (Error != GE_None)
7716 return QualType();
7717
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007718 // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the
7719 // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return.
7720 if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs)
7721 *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size();
7722
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007723 // Do array -> pointer decay. The builtin should use the decayed type.
7724 if (Ty->isArrayType())
7725 Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007726
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007727 ArgTypes.push_back(Ty);
7728 }
7729
7730 assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) &&
7731 "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!");
7732
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007733 FunctionType::ExtInfo EI(CC_C);
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00007734 if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true);
7735
7736 bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.');
7737
7738 // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here, especially in C++.
7739 if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic)
7740 return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI);
Douglas Gregor36c569f2010-02-21 22:15:06 +00007741
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007742 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00007743 EPI.ExtInfo = EI;
7744 EPI.Variadic = Variadic;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007745
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00007746 return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007747}
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00007748
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007749static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForFunction(const ASTContext &Context,
7750 const FunctionDecl *FD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007751 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007752 return GVA_Internal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007753
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007754 GVALinkage External = GVA_StrongExternal;
7755 switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
7756 case TSK_Undeclared:
7757 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
7758 External = GVA_StrongExternal;
7759 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007760
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007761 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00007762 return GVA_StrongODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007763
David Majnemerc3d07332014-05-15 06:25:57 +00007764 // C++11 [temp.explicit]p10:
7765 // [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of
7766 // an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly
7767 // instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for
7768 // inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be
7769 // generated in the translation unit. -- end note ]
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007770 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007771 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
7772
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007773 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007774 External = GVA_DiscardableODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007775 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007776 }
7777
7778 if (!FD->isInlined())
7779 return External;
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00007780
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007781 if ((!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !Context.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
7782 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) ||
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00007783 FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007784 // FIXME: This doesn't match gcc's behavior for dllexport inline functions.
7785
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007786 // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be
7787 // externally visible.
7788 if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible())
7789 return External;
7790
7791 // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible.
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007792 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007793 }
7794
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00007795 // Functions specified with extern and inline in -fms-compatibility mode
7796 // forcibly get emitted. While the body of the function cannot be later
7797 // replaced, the function definition cannot be discarded.
7798 if (FD->getMostRecentDecl()->isMSExternInline())
7799 return GVA_StrongODR;
7800
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007801 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007802}
7803
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007804static GVALinkage adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(GVALinkage L, const Decl *D) {
7805 // See http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/xa0d9ste.aspx
7806 // dllexport/dllimport on inline functions.
7807 if (D->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>()) {
7808 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_StrongODR)
7809 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
7810 } else if (D->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) {
7811 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
7812 return GVA_StrongODR;
7813 }
7814 return L;
7815}
7816
7817GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) const {
7818 return adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(basicGVALinkageForFunction(*this, FD),
7819 FD);
7820}
7821
7822static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForVariable(const ASTContext &Context,
7823 const VarDecl *VD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007824 if (!VD->isExternallyVisible())
7825 return GVA_Internal;
7826
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007827 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) {
7828 GVALinkage StaticLocalLinkage = GVA_DiscardableODR;
7829 const DeclContext *LexicalContext = VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod();
7830 while (LexicalContext && !isa<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext))
7831 LexicalContext = LexicalContext->getLexicalParent();
7832
7833 // Let the static local variable inherit it's linkage from the nearest
7834 // enclosing function.
7835 if (LexicalContext)
7836 StaticLocalLinkage =
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007837 Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(cast<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext));
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007838
7839 // GVA_StrongODR function linkage is stronger than what we need,
7840 // downgrade to GVA_DiscardableODR.
7841 // This allows us to discard the variable if we never end up needing it.
7842 return StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_StrongODR ? GVA_DiscardableODR
7843 : StaticLocalLinkage;
7844 }
7845
Richard Smith8809a0c2013-09-27 20:14:12 +00007846 switch (VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007847 case TSK_Undeclared:
7848 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
7849 return GVA_StrongExternal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007850
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007851 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00007852 return GVA_StrongODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007853
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007854 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
7855 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
7856
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007857 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007858 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007859 }
Rafael Espindola27699c82013-05-13 14:05:53 +00007860
7861 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007862}
7863
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007864GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) {
7865 return adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(basicGVALinkageForVariable(*this, VD),
7866 VD);
7867}
7868
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc9049332010-07-29 20:08:05 +00007869bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007870 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
7871 if (!VD->isFileVarDecl())
7872 return false;
Renato Golin9258aa52014-05-21 10:40:27 +00007873 // Global named register variables (GNU extension) are never emitted.
7874 if (VD->getStorageClass() == SC_Register)
7875 return false;
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00007876 } else if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
7877 // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template.
7878 if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
7879 return false;
7880 } else
7881 return false;
7882
7883 // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it.
7884 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007885 return false;
7886
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00007887 // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves.
7888 if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>())
7889 return false;
7890
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007891 // Aliases and used decls are required.
7892 if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
7893 return true;
7894
7895 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
7896 // Forward declarations aren't required.
Alexis Hunt4a8ea102011-05-06 20:44:56 +00007897 if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
Nick Lewycky26da4dd2011-07-18 05:26:13 +00007898 return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007899
7900 // Constructors and destructors are required.
7901 if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>())
7902 return true;
7903
John McCall6bd2a892013-01-25 22:31:03 +00007904 // The key function for a class is required. This rule only comes
7905 // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though.
7906 if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
7907 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
7908 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent();
7909 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) {
7910 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD);
7911 if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl())
7912 return true;
7913 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007914 }
7915 }
7916
7917 GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD);
7918
7919 // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can
7920 // always be deferred. Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++.
7921 // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++.
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007922 if (Linkage == GVA_Internal || Linkage == GVA_AvailableExternally ||
7923 Linkage == GVA_DiscardableODR)
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007924 return false;
7925 return true;
7926 }
Douglas Gregor87d81242011-09-10 00:22:34 +00007927
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007928 const VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D);
7929 assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var");
7930
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00007931 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly)
7932 return false;
7933
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00007934 // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007935 GVALinkage L = GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD);
David Majnemerc3d07332014-05-15 06:25:57 +00007936 if (L != GVA_Internal && L != GVA_AvailableExternally &&
7937 L != GVA_DiscardableODR)
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00007938 return true;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007939
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00007940 // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required.
7941 if (VD->getType().isDestructedType())
7942 return true;
7943
7944 // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required.
7945 if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this))
7946 return true;
7947
7948 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007949}
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00007950
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007951CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic,
7952 bool IsCXXMethod) const {
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00007953 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007954 if (IsCXXMethod)
7955 return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(IsVariadic);
Timur Iskhodzhanovc5098ad2012-07-12 09:50:54 +00007956
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007957 return (LangOpts.MRTD && !IsVariadic) ? CC_X86StdCall : CC_C;
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00007958}
7959
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007960bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
Anders Carlsson60a62632010-11-25 01:51:53 +00007961 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
7962 return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD);
7963}
7964
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +00007965VTableContextBase *ASTContext::getVTableContext() {
7966 if (!VTContext.get()) {
7967 if (Target->getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
7968 VTContext.reset(new MicrosoftVTableContext(*this));
7969 else
7970 VTContext.reset(new ItaniumVTableContext(*this));
7971 }
7972 return VTContext.get();
7973}
7974
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00007975MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext() {
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00007976 switch (Target->getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00007977 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00007978 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
7979 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
7980 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +00007981 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00007982 return ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00007983 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00007984 return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00007985 }
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007986 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00007987}
7988
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00007989CXXABI::~CXXABI() {}
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00007990
7991size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const {
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00007992 return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() +
7993 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) +
7994 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) +
7995 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) +
7996 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) +
7997 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) +
7998 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) +
7999 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) +
8000 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) +
8001 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) +
8002 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) +
8003 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) +
8004 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes) +
8005 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ClassScopeSpecializationPattern);
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00008006}
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008007
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00008008/// getIntTypeForBitwidth -
8009/// sets integer QualTy according to specified details:
8010/// bitwidth, signed/unsigned.
8011/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8012QualType ASTContext::getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,
8013 unsigned Signed) const {
8014 TargetInfo::IntType Ty = getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(DestWidth, Signed);
8015 CanQualType QualTy = getFromTargetType(Ty);
8016 if (!QualTy && DestWidth == 128)
8017 return Signed ? Int128Ty : UnsignedInt128Ty;
8018 return QualTy;
8019}
8020
8021/// getRealTypeForBitwidth -
8022/// sets floating point QualTy according to specified bitwidth.
8023/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8024QualType ASTContext::getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth) const {
8025 TargetInfo::RealType Ty = getTargetInfo().getRealTypeByWidth(DestWidth);
8026 switch (Ty) {
8027 case TargetInfo::Float:
8028 return FloatTy;
8029 case TargetInfo::Double:
8030 return DoubleTy;
8031 case TargetInfo::LongDouble:
8032 return LongDoubleTy;
8033 case TargetInfo::NoFloat:
8034 return QualType();
8035 }
8036
8037 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::RealType value");
8038}
8039
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008040void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) {
8041 if (Number > 1)
8042 MangleNumbers[ND] = Number;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008043}
8044
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008045unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND) const {
8046 llvm::DenseMap<const NamedDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8047 MangleNumbers.find(ND);
8048 return I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008049}
8050
David Majnemer2206bf52014-03-05 08:57:59 +00008051void ASTContext::setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD, unsigned Number) {
8052 if (Number > 1)
8053 StaticLocalNumbers[VD] = Number;
8054}
8055
8056unsigned ASTContext::getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD) const {
8057 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8058 StaticLocalNumbers.find(VD);
8059 return I != StaticLocalNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
8060}
8061
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008062MangleNumberingContext &
8063ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) {
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00008064 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus); // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C.
8065 MangleNumberingContext *&MCtx = MangleNumberingContexts[DC];
8066 if (!MCtx)
8067 MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext();
8068 return *MCtx;
8069}
8070
8071MangleNumberingContext *ASTContext::createMangleNumberingContext() const {
8072 return ABI->createMangleNumberingContext();
Douglas Gregor63798542012-02-20 19:44:39 +00008073}
8074
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008075void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) {
8076 ParamIndices[D] = index;
8077}
8078
8079unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const {
8080 ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D);
8081 assert(I != ParamIndices.end() &&
8082 "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl");
8083 return I->second;
8084}
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008085
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008086APValue *
8087ASTContext::getMaterializedTemporaryValue(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *E,
8088 bool MayCreate) {
8089 assert(E && E->getStorageDuration() == SD_Static &&
8090 "don't need to cache the computed value for this temporary");
8091 if (MayCreate)
8092 return &MaterializedTemporaryValues[E];
8093
8094 llvm::DenseMap<const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *, APValue>::iterator I =
8095 MaterializedTemporaryValues.find(E);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00008096 return I == MaterializedTemporaryValues.end() ? nullptr : &I->second;
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008097}
8098
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008099bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const {
8100 const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple();
8101 if (!T.isOSDarwin())
8102 return false;
8103
Bob Wilson2c82c3d2013-11-02 23:27:49 +00008104 if (!(T.isiOS() && T.isOSVersionLT(7)) &&
8105 !(T.isMacOSX() && T.isOSVersionLT(10, 9)))
8106 return false;
8107
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008108 QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType();
8109 CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy);
8110 uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity();
8111 CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy);
8112 unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity();
8113 unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth();
8114 return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits);
8115}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008116
8117namespace {
8118
8119 /// \brief A \c RecursiveASTVisitor that builds a map from nodes to their
8120 /// parents as defined by the \c RecursiveASTVisitor.
8121 ///
8122 /// Note that the relationship described here is purely in terms of AST
8123 /// traversal - there are other relationships (for example declaration context)
8124 /// in the AST that are better modeled by special matchers.
8125 ///
8126 /// FIXME: Currently only builds up the map using \c Stmt and \c Decl nodes.
8127 class ParentMapASTVisitor : public RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> {
8128
8129 public:
8130 /// \brief Builds and returns the translation unit's parent map.
8131 ///
8132 /// The caller takes ownership of the returned \c ParentMap.
8133 static ASTContext::ParentMap *buildMap(TranslationUnitDecl &TU) {
8134 ParentMapASTVisitor Visitor(new ASTContext::ParentMap);
8135 Visitor.TraverseDecl(&TU);
8136 return Visitor.Parents;
8137 }
8138
8139 private:
8140 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> VisitorBase;
8141
8142 ParentMapASTVisitor(ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents) : Parents(Parents) {
8143 }
8144
8145 bool shouldVisitTemplateInstantiations() const {
8146 return true;
8147 }
8148 bool shouldVisitImplicitCode() const {
8149 return true;
8150 }
8151 // Disables data recursion. We intercept Traverse* methods in the RAV, which
8152 // are not triggered during data recursion.
8153 bool shouldUseDataRecursionFor(clang::Stmt *S) const {
8154 return false;
8155 }
8156
8157 template <typename T>
8158 bool TraverseNode(T *Node, bool(VisitorBase:: *traverse) (T *)) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00008159 if (!Node)
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008160 return true;
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008161 if (ParentStack.size() > 0) {
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008162 // FIXME: Currently we add the same parent multiple times, for example
8163 // when we visit all subexpressions of template instantiations; this is
8164 // suboptimal, bug benign: the only way to visit those is with
8165 // hasAncestor / hasParent, and those do not create new matches.
8166 // The plan is to enable DynTypedNode to be storable in a map or hash
8167 // map. The main problem there is to implement hash functions /
8168 // comparison operators for all types that DynTypedNode supports that
8169 // do not have pointer identity.
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008170 auto &NodeOrVector = (*Parents)[Node];
8171 if (NodeOrVector.isNull()) {
8172 NodeOrVector = new ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode(ParentStack.back());
8173 } else if (NodeOrVector
8174 .template is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
8175 auto *Node =
8176 NodeOrVector.template get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
8177 auto *Vector = new ASTContext::ParentVector(1, *Node);
8178 Vector->push_back(ParentStack.back());
8179 NodeOrVector = Vector;
8180 delete Node;
8181 } else {
8182 assert(NodeOrVector.template is<ASTContext::ParentVector *>());
8183 NodeOrVector.template get<ASTContext::ParentVector *>()->push_back(
8184 ParentStack.back());
8185 }
8186 }
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008187 ParentStack.push_back(ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*Node));
8188 bool Result = (this ->* traverse) (Node);
8189 ParentStack.pop_back();
8190 return Result;
8191 }
8192
8193 bool TraverseDecl(Decl *DeclNode) {
8194 return TraverseNode(DeclNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseDecl);
8195 }
8196
8197 bool TraverseStmt(Stmt *StmtNode) {
8198 return TraverseNode(StmtNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseStmt);
8199 }
8200
8201 ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents;
8202 llvm::SmallVector<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 16> ParentStack;
8203
8204 friend class RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>;
8205 };
8206
8207} // end namespace
8208
8209ASTContext::ParentVector
8210ASTContext::getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode &Node) {
8211 assert(Node.getMemoizationData() &&
8212 "Invariant broken: only nodes that support memoization may be "
8213 "used in the parent map.");
8214 if (!AllParents) {
8215 // We always need to run over the whole translation unit, as
8216 // hasAncestor can escape any subtree.
8217 AllParents.reset(
8218 ParentMapASTVisitor::buildMap(*getTranslationUnitDecl()));
8219 }
8220 ParentMap::const_iterator I = AllParents->find(Node.getMemoizationData());
8221 if (I == AllParents->end()) {
8222 return ParentVector();
8223 }
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008224 if (I->second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
8225 return ParentVector(1, *I->second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>());
8226 }
8227 const auto &Parents = *I->second.get<ParentVector *>();
8228 return ParentVector(Parents.begin(), Parents.end());
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008229}
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00008230
8231bool
8232ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl,
8233 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) {
8234 // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod.
8235 if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()
8236 || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
8237 return false;
8238 if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() !=
8239 MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8240 return false;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008241 if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getReturnType(), MethodImpl->getReturnType()))
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00008242 return false;
8243
8244 if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size())
8245 return false;
8246
8247 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(),
8248 IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(),
8249 EF = MethodDecl->param_end();
8250 IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) {
8251 const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF);
8252 const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM);
8253 if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8254 return false;
8255 if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType()))
8256 return false;
8257 }
8258 return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic());
8259
8260}
Richard Smith053f6c62014-05-16 23:01:30 +00008261
8262// Explicitly instantiate this in case a Redeclarable<T> is used from a TU that
8263// doesn't include ASTContext.h
8264template
8265clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
8266 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::ValueType
8267clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
8268 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::makeValue(
8269 const clang::ASTContext &Ctx, Decl *Value);